blob: 65aabd892cb51a033a7c7db86c88a086712a2d48 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau1db55792020-11-05 17:20:35 +01005 version 2.4
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaudc626ec2021-02-13 10:17:27 +01007 2021/02/13
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100442.4. Conditional blocks
452.5. Time format
462.6. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020047
483. Global parameters
493.1. Process management and security
503.2. Performance tuning
513.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100523.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200533.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200543.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200553.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100563.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200573.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100583.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
604. Proxies
614.1. Proxy keywords matrix
624.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
63
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100645. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200655.1. Bind options
665.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200675.3. Server DNS resolution
685.3.1. Global overview
695.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100716. Cache
726.1. Limitation
736.2. Setup
746.2.1. Cache section
756.2.2. Proxy section
76
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200777. Using ACLs and fetching samples
787.1. ACL basics
797.1.1. Matching booleans
807.1.2. Matching integers
817.1.3. Matching strings
827.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
837.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
847.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
857.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
867.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200877.3.1. Converters
887.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
897.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
907.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
917.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
927.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200937.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200947.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095
968. Logging
978.1. Log levels
988.2. Log formats
998.2.1. Default log format
1008.2.2. TCP log format
1018.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001028.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001038.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001048.3. Advanced logging options
1058.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1068.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1078.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1088.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1098.4. Timing events
1108.5. Session state at disconnection
1118.6. Non-printable characters
1128.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1138.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1148.9. Examples of logs
115
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001169. Supported filters
1179.1. Trace
1189.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001199.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001209.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001219.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001229.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200123
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012410. FastCGI applications
12510.1. Setup
12610.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12710.1.2. Proxy section
12810.1.3. Example
12910.2. Default parameters
13010.3. Limitations
131
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200132
1331. Quick reminder about HTTP
134----------------------------
135
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100136When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
138on almost anything found in the contents.
139
140However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
141formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
142correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
143
144
1451.1. The HTTP transaction model
146-------------------------------
147
148The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100149to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100150from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
151connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152will involve a new connection :
153
154 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
155
156In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
157establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
158by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
159length.
160
161Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
162to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
163however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
164response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
165header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
166
167 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
168
169Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
170power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
171but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200172a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100174Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200175keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
176second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
177page :
178
179 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
180
181This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
182latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
183correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
184the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100185server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200186
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100187The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
188time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
189are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
190parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
191carry the stream identifier.
192
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100193By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
194connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
195leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100196start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
197processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
198waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200199
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200200HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100201 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
202 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100203 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100204 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200205 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100206
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100207
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208
2091.2. HTTP request
210-----------------
211
212First, let's consider this HTTP request :
213
214 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100215 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200216 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
217 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
218 3 User-agent: my small browser
219 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
220 5 Accept: image/png
221
222
2231.2.1. The Request line
224-----------------------
225
226Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
227
228 - a METHOD : GET
229 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
230 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
231
232All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
233which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
234followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
235is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
236desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
237the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
238
239The URI itself can have several forms :
240
241 - A "relative URI" :
242
243 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
244
245 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
246 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
247
248 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
249
250 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
251
252 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
253 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
254 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
255 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
256 must accept this form too.
257
258 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
259 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
260 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100261
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200262 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
263 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
264 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
265 other protocols too.
266
267In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
268mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
269on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
270It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
271specific to the language, framework or application in use.
272
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100273HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100274assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100275
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200276
2771.2.2. The request headers
278--------------------------
279
280The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
281beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
282an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
283Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
284values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
285encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
286the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
287define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
288
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100289Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200290their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100291"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200292as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
293normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
294representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
295HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200296
297The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
298that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
299is one valid form of empty line.
300
301Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
302headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
303about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
304application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
305
306Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000307 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200308 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
309 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
310 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
311
312
3131.3. HTTP response
314------------------
315
316An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
317messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
318
319 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100320 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200321 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
322 2 Content-length: 350
323 3 Content-Type: text/html
324
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200325As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
326codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
327response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100328continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
329the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
330following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
331sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
332(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
333correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
334such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
335state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
336over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
337if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
338information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200339
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200340
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003411.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200342------------------------
343
344Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
345
346 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
347 - a status code : 200
348 - a reason : OK
349
350The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100351 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
352 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
353 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
354 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
355 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200356
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000357Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100358"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200359found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
360messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
361or "Authentication Required".
362
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100363HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200364
365 Code When / reason
366 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
367 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
368 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
369 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100370 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
371 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200372 400 for an invalid or too large request
373 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
374 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200375 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100376 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200377 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100378 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
379 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200380 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
381 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100382 501 when haproxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
383 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200384 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200385 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200386 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
387 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
388 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
389
390The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3914.2).
392
393
3941.3.2. The response headers
395---------------------------
396
397Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
398the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
399details.
400
401
4022. Configuring HAProxy
403----------------------
404
4052.1. Configuration file format
406------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200407
408HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
409
410 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100411 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700412 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100413 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200414
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100415The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
416a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100417
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100418 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
419
420 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
421
422 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
423 tab characters
424
425 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
426 keyword sequences listed in this document
427
428 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
429 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
430 parts of the configuration, or expressions
431
432 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
433 are supported
434
435 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
436 section
437
438This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
439generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
440figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
441
442First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
443the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
444a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
445word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
446follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
447the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
448the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
449the parts that need to be addressed.
450
451A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
452requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
453extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
454the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
455section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
456section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
457not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
458
459A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
460each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
461a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
462start a new one.
463
464Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
465that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
466applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
467"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
468processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
469ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
470which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
471In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
472of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
473identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
474such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4752, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
476
477 listen foo
478 bind :80
479
480 listen bar
481 bind :81
482
483Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
484spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
485of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
486following configurations are strictly equivalent:
487
488 global#this is the global section
489 daemon#daemonize
490 frontend foo
491 mode http # or tcp
492
493and:
494
495 global
496 daemon
497
498 # this is the public web frontend
499 frontend foo
500 mode http
501
502The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
503new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
504other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
505section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
506section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
507at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
508
509Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
510are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
511editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
512support automatic indent.
513
514In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
515positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
516modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
517anymore, and is not recommended.
518
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200519
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005202.2. Quoting and escaping
521-------------------------
522
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100523In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
524that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
525possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
526in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
527('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200528
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100529This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
530very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
531the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
532also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
533delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
534word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
535remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200536
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100537If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
538(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
539
540Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
541backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200542
543 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
544 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
545 \\ to use a backslash
546 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
547 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
548
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100549In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
550C-language representation:
551
552 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
553 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
554 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
555 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
556
557Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
558or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
559of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200560
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100561 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200562 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
563 # hash as a comment start
564
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100565Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
566evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
567dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
568backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200569
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100570Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
571character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
572is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200573
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100574As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
575entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
576name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
577represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
578hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200579
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100580 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
581 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
582 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
583 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
584 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
585 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
586 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
587 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
588 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
589 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
590 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200591
592 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100593 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200594 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
595 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
596 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
597 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
598 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
599
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100600There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
601necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
602by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
603they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
604escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
605characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
606case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
607if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
608own quotes.
609
610The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
611quotes, except that is will not make special cases of backslashes. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500612not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100613quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
614
615Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
616arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
617
618 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
619 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
620
621Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
622"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
623cannot write:
624
625 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
626
627because we would like the string to cut like this:
628
629 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
630 |---------|----|-|
631 arg1 _/ / /
632 arg2 __________/ /
633 arg3 ______________/
634
635but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
636parenthesis then garbage:
637
638 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
639 |--------|--------|
640 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
641 trailing garbage _________/
642
643The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
644quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
645processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
646this word:
647
648 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
649 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
650 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
651
652So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
653still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
654the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
655the second level:
656
657 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
658 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
659 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
660 |---------||----|-|
661 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
662 arg2=blah ___________/ /
663 arg3=g _______________/
664
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500665Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100666double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
667
668 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
669 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
670 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
671 |---------||----|-|
672 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
673 arg2 ___________/ /
674 arg3 _______________/
675
676When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
677appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
678string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
679thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
680
681 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
682 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
683 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
684 |-------------| |-----||-|
685 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
686 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
687 arg3 ______________________/
688
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500689Remember that backslahes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100690that the whole word3 above is already protected against them using the single
691quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
692single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
693level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
694
695When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
696double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
697and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash of the string contains
698a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
699a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
700the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
701regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
702around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
703more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200704
705
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007062.3. Environment variables
707--------------------------
708
709HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
710interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
711configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
712optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
713shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200714underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
715list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
716arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
717before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200718
719 Example:
720
721 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
722
723 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
724
725 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
726
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200727Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
728file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200729
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200730* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
731 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
732
733* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
734 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
735 directory.
736
737* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
738
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500739* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200740 processes, separated by semicolons.
741
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500742* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200743 CLI, separated by semicolons.
744
745See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200746
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100747
7482.4. Conditional blocks
749-----------------------
750
751It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
752some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
753ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
754configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
755versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
756preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
757text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
758lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
759switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
760are defined to form conditional blocks:
761
762 - .if <condition>
763 - .elif <condition>
764 - .else
765 - .endif
766
767The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
768as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
769matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
770there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
771only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
772".elif" of a block.
773
774Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
775ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
776as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
777
778The conditions are currently limited to:
779
780 - an empty string, always returns "false"
781 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
782 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
783
784Other patterns are not supported yet but the purpose is to bring a few
785functions to test for certain build options and supported features.
786
787Three other directives are provided to report some status:
788
789 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
790 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
791 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
792
793Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
794"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
795fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
796provide advice to the user.
797
798Example:
799
800 .if "${A}"
801 .if "${B}"
802 .notice "A=1, B=1"
803 .elif "${C}"
804 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
805 .elif "${D}"
806 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
807 .else
808 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
809 .endif
810 .else
811 .notice "A=0"
812 .endif
813
814
8152.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200816----------------
817
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100818Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100819values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
820otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
821numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
822for every keyword. Supported units are :
823
824 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
825 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
826 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
827 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
828 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
829 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
830
831
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +01008322.6. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200833-------------
834
835 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
836 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
837 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
838 global
839 daemon
840 maxconn 256
841
842 defaults
843 mode http
844 timeout connect 5000ms
845 timeout client 50000ms
846 timeout server 50000ms
847
848 frontend http-in
849 bind *:80
850 default_backend servers
851
852 backend servers
853 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
854
855
856 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
857 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
858 global
859 daemon
860 maxconn 256
861
862 defaults
863 mode http
864 timeout connect 5000ms
865 timeout client 50000ms
866 timeout server 50000ms
867
868 listen http-in
869 bind *:80
870 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
871
872
873Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
874
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100875 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200876
877
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008783. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200879--------------------
880
881Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
882are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
883of them have command-line equivalents.
884
885The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
886
887 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200888 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200889 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200890 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200891 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200892 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200893 - description
894 - deviceatlas-json-file
895 - deviceatlas-log-level
896 - deviceatlas-separator
897 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900898 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200899 - gid
900 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100901 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200902 - h1-case-adjust
903 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100904 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100905 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100906 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200907 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200908 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200909 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100910 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200911 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +0100912 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100913 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200914 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200915 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200916 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200917 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200918 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +0200919 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100920 - presetenv
921 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200922 - uid
923 - ulimit-n
924 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200925 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100926 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200927 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200928 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200929 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200930 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200931 - ssl-default-bind-options
932 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200933 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200934 - ssl-default-server-options
935 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100936 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200937 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100938 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100939 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100940 - 51degrees-data-file
941 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200942 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200943 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200944 - wurfl-data-file
945 - wurfl-information-list
946 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200947 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100948 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100949
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200950 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100951 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200952 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200953 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200954 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100955 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100956 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100957 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200958 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200959 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200960 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200961 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200962 - noepoll
963 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000964 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200965 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100966 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300967 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000968 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100969 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200970 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200971 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200972 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000973 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000974 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200975 - tune.buffers.limit
976 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200977 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200978 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100979 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +0200980 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200981 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200982 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200983 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100984 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200985 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200986 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +0200987 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100988 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100989 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100990 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100991 - tune.lua.session-timeout
992 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200993 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100994 - tune.maxaccept
995 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200996 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200997 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200998 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +0200999 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1000 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001001 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1002 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001003 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001004 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001005 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001006 - tune.sndbuf.client
1007 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001008 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001009 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001010 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001011 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001012 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001013 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001014 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001015 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001016 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001017 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001018 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1019 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1020 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001021 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1022 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001023
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001024 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001025 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001026 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001027
1028
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010293.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001030------------------------------------
1031
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001032ca-base <dir>
1033 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001034 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1035 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1036 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001037
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001038chroot <jail dir>
1039 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1040 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1041 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1042 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1043 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001044 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001045
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001046cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
1047 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
1048 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
1049 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
1050 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
1051 set. These sets have the format
1052
1053 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1054
1055 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001056 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001057 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
1058 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001059 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
1060 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001061 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001062 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001063 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001064 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001065 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
1066 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
1067 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
1068 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001069
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001070 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1071 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1072 on the machine's word size.
1073
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001074 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001075 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
1076 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
1077 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
1078 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
1079 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
1080 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001081
1082 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001083 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
1084
1085 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1086 # first 4 CPUs
1087
1088 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
1089 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
1090 # word size.
1091
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001092 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001093 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001094 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
1095 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
1096 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
1097
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001098 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1099 # and so on.
1100 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1101 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1102 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1103
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001104 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001105 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
1106 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
1107 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
1108
1109 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
1110 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
1111 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
1112
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001113 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
1114 # and a thread range.
1115 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
1116 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
1117 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
1118
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001119crt-base <dir>
1120 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001121 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1122 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001123
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001124daemon
1125 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1126 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001127 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1128 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001129
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001130deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1131 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001132 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001133
1134deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001135 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001136 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1137
1138deviceatlas-separator <char>
1139 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1140 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1141
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001142deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001143 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1144 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1145 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001146
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001147external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001148 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1149 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001150 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1151 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1152 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1153 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1154 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001155
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001156gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001157 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001158 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1159 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001160 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
1161 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001162 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001163
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001164group <group name>
1165 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1166 See also "gid" and "user".
1167
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001168hard-stop-after <time>
1169 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1170
1171 Arguments :
1172 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1173 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1174 SIGUSR1 signal.
1175
1176 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1177 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1178 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1179
1180 Example:
1181 global
1182 hard-stop-after 30s
1183
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001184h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1185 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1186 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1187 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1188 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001189 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001190 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1191 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1192 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1193 specified in a proxy.
1194
1195 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1196 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1197 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1198 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1199 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1200 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1201 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1202
1203 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1204 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1205 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1206 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1207 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1208
1209 Example:
1210 global
1211 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1212
1213 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1214 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1215
1216h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1217 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1218 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1219 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1220 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1221 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1222 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1223 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1224 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1225
1226 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1227 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1228 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1229
1230 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1231 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1232
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001233insecure-fork-wanted
1234 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
1235 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1236 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1237 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1238 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1239 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1240 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1241 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
1242 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
1243 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1244 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1245 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1246 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1247 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1248 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1249 disable it.
1250
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001251insecure-setuid-wanted
1252 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1253 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1254 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1255 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
1256 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
1257 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
1258 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
1259 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1260 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
1261 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
1262 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1263 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1264 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1265 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1266
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001267issuers-chain-path <dir>
1268 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1269 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1270 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
1271 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
1272 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1273 "issuers-chain-path".
1274 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1275 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1276 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1277 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1278 will share the chain in memory.
1279
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001280localpeer <name>
1281 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1282 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1283 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1284 the configuration parsing.
1285
1286 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1287 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1288
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001289log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001290 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001291 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001292 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001293 configured with "log global".
1294
1295 <address> can be one of:
1296
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001297 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001298 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1299 port).
1300
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001301 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1302 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1303 port).
1304
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001305 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001306 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1307 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001308 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001309
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001310 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1311 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1312 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1313 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1314 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1315 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1316 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1317 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1318 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1319 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1320 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1321 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1322 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1323 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001324 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1325 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001326
1327 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1328 "fd@2", see above.
1329
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001330 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1331 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1332 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1333 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1334 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1335
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001336 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1337 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001338
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001339 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1340 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1341 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1342 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1343 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1344 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1345 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1346 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1347 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1348 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001349 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1350 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001351
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001352 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1353 one of the following :
1354
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001355 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1356 field is stripped. This is the default.
1357 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1358 rfc3164.
1359
1360 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001361 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1362
1363 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1364 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1365
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001366 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1367 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1368 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1369 designed to be used with a local log server.
1370
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001371 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1372 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1373 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1374 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1375 logger consumes.
1376
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001377 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1378 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1379 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1380 used with a local log server.
1381
1382 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1383 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1384 designed to be used with a local log server.
1385
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001386 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1387 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1388 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1389 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1390
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001391 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1392 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1393 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1394 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1395 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1396
1397 <sample_size>
1398 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1399 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1400 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1401 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1402 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1403
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001404 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001405
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001406 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1407 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1408 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1409
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001410 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1411 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1412 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1413 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001414
1415 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001416 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1417 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1418 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1419 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1420 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1421 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001422
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001423 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001424
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001425log-send-hostname [<string>]
1426 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1427 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1428 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1429 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1430 the logs.
1431
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001432log-tag <string>
1433 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1434 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1435 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001436 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001437
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001438lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001439 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1440 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1441 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1442 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1443 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1444 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001445 used multiple times.
1446
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001447lua-load-per-thread <file>
1448 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1449 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1450 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1451 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1452 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1453 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1454 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1455 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1456 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1457 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1458 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1459 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1460 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1461 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1462 times.
1463
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001464lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1465 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1466 variable.
1467 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1468 to "path".
1469
1470 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1471 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1472 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1473 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1474 will be checked earlier.
1475
1476 As an example by specifying the following path:
1477
1478 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1479 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1480
1481 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1482 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1483 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1484 paths if that does not exist either.
1485
1486 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1487 documentation.
1488
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001489master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001490 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1491 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1492 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001493 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001494 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1495 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001496 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1497 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1498 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1499 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1500 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001501
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001502 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001503
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001504mworker-max-reloads <number>
1505 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001506 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001507 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1508 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1509 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1510
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001511nbproc <number> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001512 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1513 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1514 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001515 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1516 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001517 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. This directive is deprecated
1518 and scheduled for removal in 2.5. Please use "nbthread" instead. See also
1519 "daemon" and "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001520
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001521nbthread <number>
1522 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001523 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1524 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1525 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1526 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1527 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001528 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1529 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1530 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1531 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1532 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1533 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1534 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001535
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001536pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001537 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1538 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1539 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1540 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001541
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001542pp2-never-send-local
1543 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1544 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1545 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1546 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1547 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1548 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1549 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1550 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1551 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1552 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1553 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1554
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001555presetenv <name> <value>
1556 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1557 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1558 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1559 and "unsetenv".
1560
1561resetenv [<name> ...]
1562 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1563 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1564 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1565 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1566 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1567 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1568 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1569 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1570
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001571stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001572 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1573 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1574 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1575 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1576 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1577 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001578 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001579 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1580 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1581 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1582 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001583
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001584server-state-base <directory>
1585 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001586 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1587 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001588
1589server-state-file <file>
1590 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1591 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1592 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1593 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1594 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1595 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1596 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1597 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001598 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1599 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001600
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001601setenv <name> <value>
1602 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1603 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1604 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1605 and "unsetenv".
1606
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001607set-dumpable
1608 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001609 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1610 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1611 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1612 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1613 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1614 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1615 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1616 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1617 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1618 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1619 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1620 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1621 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1622 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1623 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1624 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1625 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001626
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001627ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1628 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1629 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001630 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001631 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001632 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1633 information and recommendations see e.g.
1634 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1635 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1636 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1637 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001638
1639ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1640 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1641 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1642 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1643 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1644 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001645 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1646 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1647 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001648 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001649
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001650ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1651 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1652 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1653 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1654 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1655 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1656
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001657ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1658 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1659 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1660 keyword to see available options.
1661
1662 Example:
1663 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001664 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001665
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001666ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1667 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1668 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001669 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001670 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001671 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1672 information and recommendations see e.g.
1673 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1674 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1675 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1676 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1677 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001678
1679ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1680 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1681 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1682 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1683 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1684 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001685 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1686 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1687 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1688 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001689
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001690ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1691 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1692 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1693 keyword to see available options.
1694
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001695ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1696 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1697 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1698 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001699 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001700 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001701 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1702 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1703 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1704 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001705 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1706 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1707 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1708
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001709ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1710 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1711 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001712 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001713 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001714 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1715
1716 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001717
1718 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1719 and won't try to remove them.
1720
1721 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1722
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001723ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001724 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Jerome Magnin587be9c2020-09-07 11:55:57 +02001725 the loading of the SSL certificates associated to "bind" lines. It does not
1726 apply to certificates used for client authentication on "server" lines.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001727
1728 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1729 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1730 optimize the startup time.
1731
1732 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1733 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1734 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1735
1736 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001737 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001738
1739 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001740 will try to load a "cert bundle".
1741
1742 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1743 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1744 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1745 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1746 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
1747 bind configuration..
1748
1749 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
1750 haproxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
1751 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1752 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1753 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1754 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1755 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
1756 this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
1757
1758 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1759
1760 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
1761 a cert bundle.
1762
1763 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1764 separately in several "crt".
1765
1766 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1767 since files are loading separately.
1768
1769 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
1770 required to commit them.
1771
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02001772 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001773 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001774
1775 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1776
1777 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1778
1779 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1780 not provided in the PEM file.
1781
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001782 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1783 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1784
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001785 The default behavior is "all".
1786
1787 Example:
1788 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1789 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1790 ssl-load-extra-files none
1791
1792 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1793
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001794ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1795 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1796 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1797 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1798
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001799ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001800 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001801 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1802 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1803 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1804 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1805 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1806 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02001807 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001808
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001809stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1810 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1811 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1812 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001813 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001814 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001815
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001816 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1817 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1818 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001819
1820stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1821 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1822 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001823 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001824
1825stats maxconn <connections>
1826 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1827 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1828
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001829uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001830 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001831 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1832 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1833 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1834
1835ulimit-n <number>
1836 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1837 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1838 option.
1839
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001840unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1841 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1842
1843 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1844 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1845 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1846 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1847 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1848 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1849 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1850 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1851 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1852 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1853
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001854unsetenv [<name> ...]
1855 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1856 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1857 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1858 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1859 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1860 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1861 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1862
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001863user <user name>
1864 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1865 See also "uid" and "group".
1866
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001867node <name>
1868 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1869
1870 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1871 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1872 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1873 traffic.
1874
1875description <text>
1876 Add a text that describes the instance.
1877
1878 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1879 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1880 "<" and ">" characters.
1881
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100188251degrees-data-file <file path>
1883 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001884 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001885
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001886 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001887 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1888
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000188951degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001890 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1891 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1892 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1893
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001894 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001895 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1896
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200189751degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001898 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1899 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1900
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001901 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1902 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1903
190451degrees-cache-size <number>
1905 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1906 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1907 By default, this cache is disabled.
1908
1909 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001910 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1911
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001912wurfl-data-file <file path>
1913 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1914 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1915
1916 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1917 with USE_WURFL=1.
1918
1919wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1920 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1921 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1922 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1923
1924 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1925
1926 Valid WURFL properties are:
1927 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1928
1929 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1930 device.
1931
1932 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1933 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1934
1935 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1936 particular web request.
1937
1938 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1939 used Libwurfl API version.
1940
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001941 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1942 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1943
1944 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1945 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1946
1947 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1948
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001949 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1950 with USE_WURFL=1.
1951
1952wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1953 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1954 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1955
1956 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1957 with USE_WURFL=1.
1958
1959wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1960 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1961 thus before the chroot.
1962
1963 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1964 with USE_WURFL=1.
1965
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001966wurfl-cache-size <size>
1967 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1968 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001969 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001970 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001971
1972 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1973 with USE_WURFL=1.
1974
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001975strict-limits
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01001976 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy tries to set the
1977 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
1978 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
1979 haproxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
1980 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001981
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019823.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001983-----------------------
1984
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001985busy-polling
1986 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1987 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1988 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1989 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1990 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1991 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1992 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1993 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1994 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1995 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1996 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1997 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1998 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1999 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2000 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2001 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2002 "poll" pollers.
2003
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002004 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2005 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2006 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2007
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002008max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
2009 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
2010 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2011 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2012 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2013 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2014 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2015 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2016 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2017
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002018maxconn <number>
2019 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2020 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2021 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002022 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2023 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2024 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2025 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002026 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2027 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2028 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2029 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2030 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
2031 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002032
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002033maxconnrate <number>
2034 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2035 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2036 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2037 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2038 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2039 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2040 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2041 fairness.
2042
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002043maxcomprate <number>
2044 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002045 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002046 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2047 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2048 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002049 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002050 default value.
2051
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002052maxcompcpuusage <number>
2053 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2054 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2055 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
2056 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
2057 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
2058 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
2059 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
2060 process down and from introducing high latencies.
2061
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002062maxpipes <number>
2063 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2064 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2065 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2066 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2067 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2068 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2069
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002070maxsessrate <number>
2071 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2072 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2073 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2074 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2075 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2076 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2077 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2078 fairness.
2079
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002080maxsslconn <number>
2081 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2082 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2083 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2084 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2085 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2086 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2087 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002088 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2089 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2090 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2091 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
2092 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
2093 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2094 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002095
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002096maxsslrate <number>
2097 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2098 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2099 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2100 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2101 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2102 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2103 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2104 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2105 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2106 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2107
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002108maxzlibmem <number>
2109 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2110 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2111 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002112 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2113 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2114 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2115
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002116noepoll
2117 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2118 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002119 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002120
2121nokqueue
2122 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2123 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2124 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2125
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002126noevports
2127 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2128 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2129 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2130 also "nopoll".
2131
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002132nopoll
2133 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2134 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002135 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002136 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2137 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002138
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002139nosplice
2140 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002141 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002142 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002143 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002144 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2145 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2146 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2147 "option splice-response".
2148
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002149nogetaddrinfo
2150 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2151 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2152
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00002153noreuseport
2154 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2155 command line argument "-dR".
2156
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002157profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2158 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2159 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2160 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2161 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002162 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002163 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2164 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2165 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2166 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2167
2168 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2169 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2170 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2171 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2172 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002173 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2174 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2175 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2176 CLI.
2177
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002178spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002179 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2180 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2181 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2182 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2183 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2184 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002185
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002186ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002187 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002188 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002189 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
2190 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
2191 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2192 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2193 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002194 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2195 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002196 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2197 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2198 openssl configuration file uses:
2199 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2200
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002201ssl-mode-async
2202 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002203 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002204 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2205 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
2206 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002207 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002208 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002209
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002210tune.buffers.limit <number>
2211 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2212 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2213 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2214 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2215 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002216 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002217 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2218 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2219 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2220 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2221 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2222 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2223 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2224 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
2225 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
2226
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002227tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2228 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2229 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2230 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
2231 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
2232
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002233tune.bufsize <number>
2234 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2235 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2236 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2237 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2238 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2239 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2240 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002241 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2242 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
2243 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002244 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002245 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
2246 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2247 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002248
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01002249tune.chksize <number> (deprecated)
2250 This option is deprecated and ignored.
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02002251
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002252tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2253 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2254 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2255 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2256 this value. The default value is 1.
2257
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002258tune.fail-alloc
2259 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2260 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2261 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2262 gracefully.
2263
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002264tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2265 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2266 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2267 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2268 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2269 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2270
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002271tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2272 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2273 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2274 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2275 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2276 change it.
2277
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002278tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2279 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002280 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
2281 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002282 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2283 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2284 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2285 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2286 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2287
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002288tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2289 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2290 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2291 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2292 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2293 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
2294 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
2295 recommended not to change this value.
2296
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002297tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
2298 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
2299 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
2300 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
2301 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2302 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2303 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2304 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2305
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002306tune.http.cookielen <number>
2307 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2308 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2309 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2310 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2311 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2312 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2313 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2314 to change this value.
2315
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002316tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002317 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2318 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002319 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002320 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002321 configuration directives too.
2322 The default value is 1024.
2323
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002324tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2325 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2326 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2327 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2328 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2329 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2330 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002331 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2332 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2333 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002334
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002335tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2336 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2337 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2338 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2339 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2340 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2341 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002342 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2343 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2344 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2345 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2346 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002347
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002348tune.idletimer <timeout>
2349 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
2350 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2351 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2352 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2353 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
2354 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002355 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002356 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002357 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2358
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002359tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2360 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2361 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2362 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2363 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2364 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2365 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2366 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2367 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2368 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2369
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002370tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2371 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002372 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002373 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2374 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002375 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002376 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2377 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2378
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002379tune.lua.maxmem
2380 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2381 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2382 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2383 memory.
2384
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002385tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2386 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002387 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2388 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002389 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002390
2391tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2392 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2393 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2394 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2395 check servers.
2396
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002397tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2398 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2399 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2400 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002401 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002402
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002403tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002404 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2405 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
2406 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
2407 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
2408 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
2409 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
2410 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
2411 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
2412 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
2413 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002414
2415tune.maxpollevents <number>
2416 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2417 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2418 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2419 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2420 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2421
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002422tune.maxrewrite <number>
2423 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2424 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2425 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2426 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2427 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2428 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2429 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2430 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2431 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2432 bufsize.
2433
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002434tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2435 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2436 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2437 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2438 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2439 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2440 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2441 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2442 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2443 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002444 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2445 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002446 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2447 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2448 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2449 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2450 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2451 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2452 setting this parameter to 0.
2453
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002454tune.pipesize <number>
2455 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2456 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2457 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2458 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2459 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2460 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2461
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002462tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2463 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2464 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2465 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2466 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2467 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2468 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002469 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002470
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002471tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2472 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2473 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2474 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2475 default is 20.
2476
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002477tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2478tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2479 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2480 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2481 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002482 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002483 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002484 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2485 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2486
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002487tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002488 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002489 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2490 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2491 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2492 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2493
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002494tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002495 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau4327d0a2021-02-19 15:11:55 +01002496 tasks. The default value is 40 which tends to show the highest request rates
2497 and lowest latencies. Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os,
2498 making it too small can incur extra overhead. When experimenting with much
2499 larger values, it may be useful to also enable tune.sched.low-latency and
2500 possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the maximum latency to the lowest
2501 possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002502
2503tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2504 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
2505 haproxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
2506 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2507 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2508 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2509 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2510 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2511 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2512 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002513
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002514tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2515tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2516 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2517 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2518 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002519 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002520 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002521 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2522 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2523 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2524 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2525 notifying haproxy again.
2526
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002527tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002528 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01002529 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
2530 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
2531 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
2532 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
2533 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
2534 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
2535 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
2536 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
2537 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
2538 pre-allocated upon startup and are shared between all processes if "nbproc"
2539 is greater than 1. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002540
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002541tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002542 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002543 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2544 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2545 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2546 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2547 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2548
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002549tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2550 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2551 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2552 performances. This is disabled by default.
2553
2554 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2555 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2556
2557 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2558
2559 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2560
2561 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2562
2563 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2564 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2565 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2566
2567 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2568 converted.
2569
2570 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2571 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2572 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2573 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2574 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2575 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2576 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002577 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2578 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002579
2580 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2581
2582 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2583 only need this line:
2584
2585 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2586
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002587tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2588 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002589 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002590 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2591 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2592 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2593 being used for too long.
2594
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002595tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2596 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2597 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2598 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2599 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2600 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2601 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2602 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2603 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2604 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2605 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002606 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002607 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002608
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002609tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2610 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2611 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2612 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2613 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002614 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002615 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2616 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002617 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2618 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002619
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002620tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2621 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2622 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2623 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2624 1000 entries.
2625
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002626tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2627 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2628 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2629 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2630
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002631tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002632tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002633tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2634tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2635tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002636 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2637 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2638 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2639 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2640 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2641 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2642 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2643 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002644
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002645 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2646 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2647 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2648 all available space is consumed.
2649 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2650 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2651 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002652
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002653tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2654 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002655 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002656 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002657 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002658 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2659
2660tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2661 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2662 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002663 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2664 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002665
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026663.3. Debugging
2667--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002668
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002669quiet
2670 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2671 line argument "-q".
2672
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002673zero-warning
2674 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2675 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2676 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2677 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2678 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2679 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2680
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002681
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010026823.4. Userlists
2683--------------
2684It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2685http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2686it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2687
2688userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002689 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002690 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2691
2692group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002693 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002694 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2695 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2696
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002697user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2698 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002699 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2700 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002701 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2702 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2703 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2704 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002705
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002706 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2707 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2708 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2709 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2710 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2711 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2712 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2713 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2714 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002715
2716 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002717 userlist L1
2718 group G1 users tiger,scott
2719 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002720
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002721 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2722 user scott insecure-password elgato
2723 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002724
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002725 userlist L2
2726 group G1
2727 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002728
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002729 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2730 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2731 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002732
2733 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002734
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002735
27363.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002737----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002738It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2739several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2740instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2741values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2742automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2743In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2744using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2745tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2746reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2747Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2748that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2749each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002750
2751peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002752 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002753 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2754
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002755bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2756 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2757 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2758
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002759disabled
2760 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2761 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2762 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2763
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002764default-bind [param*]
2765 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2766
2767default-server [param*]
2768 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2769
2770 Arguments:
2771 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2772 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2773 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2774 details.
2775
2776
2777 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2778
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002779enable
2780 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2781
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01002782log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002783 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2784 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2785 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2786 more details.
2787
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002788peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002789 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2790 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002791 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
2792 haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
2793 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2794 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2795 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002796
2797 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2798 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2799
2800 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002801 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2802 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2803 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002804
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002805 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2806 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002807
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002808 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2809 "server" keyword explanation below).
2810
2811server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002812 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002813 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2814 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2815 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2816 of this "peers" section).
2817 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2818
2819
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002820 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002821 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002822 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002823 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2824 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2825 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002826
2827 backend mybackend
2828 mode tcp
2829 balance roundrobin
2830 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2831 stick on src
2832
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002833 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2834 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002835
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002836 Example:
2837 peers mypeers
2838 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2839 default-server ssl verify none
2840 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2841 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002842
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002843
2844table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2845 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2846
2847 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2848 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002849 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002850 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2851 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2852 "stick-table" keyword).
2853
2854 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2855 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2856 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2857 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2858 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2859 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2860 of the stick-table name as follows:
2861
2862 peers mypeers
2863 peer A ...
2864 peer B ...
2865 table t1 ...
2866
2867 frontend fe1
2868 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2869
2870 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2871 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2872
2873 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2874 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2875 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2876 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2877 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2878 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2879 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2880
2881 peers mypeers
2882 peer A ...
2883 peer B ...
2884 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2885
2886 backend t1
2887 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2888
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002889 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002890 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2891 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2892
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090028933.6. Mailers
2894------------
2895It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2896If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2897in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2898
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002899mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002900 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2901 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2902
2903mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2904 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2905
2906 Example:
2907 mailers mymailers
2908 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2909 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2910
2911 backend mybackend
2912 mode tcp
2913 balance roundrobin
2914
2915 email-alert mailers mymailers
2916 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2917 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2918
2919 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2920 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2921
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002922timeout mail <time>
2923 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2924 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2925 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2926 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2927
2928 Example:
2929 mailers mymailers
2930 timeout mail 20s
2931 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002932
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020029333.7. Programs
2934-------------
2935In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2936master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2937managed the same way as the workers.
2938
2939During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2940sequence as a worker:
2941
2942 - the master is re-executed
2943 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2944 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2945 instance of the program
2946
2947During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2948
2949program <name>
2950 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2951 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2952 the management guide).
2953
2954command <command> [arguments*]
2955 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2956 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2957 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2958 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2959
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002960user <user name>
2961 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2962 See also "group".
2963
2964group <group name>
2965 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2966 See also "user".
2967
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002968option start-on-reload
2969no option start-on-reload
2970 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2971 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2972 program section.
2973
2974
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010029753.8. HTTP-errors
2976----------------
2977
2978It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2979imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2980several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2981
2982http-errors <name>
2983 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2984 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2985
2986errorfile <code> <file>
2987 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2988
2989 Arguments :
2990 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02002991 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01002992 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002993
2994 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2995 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2996 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2997 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2998 before any chroot is performed.
2999
3000 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3001
3002 Example:
3003 http-errors website-1
3004 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3005 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3006 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3007
3008 http-errors website-2
3009 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3010 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3011 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3012
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020030133.9. Rings
3014----------
3015
3016It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3017servers or traces.
3018
3019ring <ringname>
3020 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3021
3022description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003023 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003024 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3025
3026format <format>
3027 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3028
3029 Arguments:
3030 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3031 one of the following :
3032
3033 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3034 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3035 designed to be used with a local log server.
3036
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003037 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3038 field is stripped. This is the default.
3039 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3040 rfc3164.
3041
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003042 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3043 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3044 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3045 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3046 is the default.
3047
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003048 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003049 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3050
3051 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3052 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3053
3054 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3055 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3056 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3057 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3058 logger consumes.
3059
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003060 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3061 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3062 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3063 with a local log server.
3064
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003065 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3066 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3067 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3068 used with a local log server.
3069
3070maxlen <length>
3071 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3072 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3073 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3074
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003075server <name> <address> [param*]
3076 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3077 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3078 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3079 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3080 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3081 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3082 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3083 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3084 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003085 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3086 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003087
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003088size <size>
3089 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3090 set to BUFSIZE.
3091
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003092timeout connect <timeout>
3093 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3094
3095 Arguments :
3096 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3097 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3098 as explained at the top of this document.
3099
3100timeout server <timeout>
3101 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3102
3103 Arguments :
3104 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3105 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3106 as explained at the top of this document.
3107
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003108 Example:
3109 global
3110 log ring@myring local7
3111
3112 ring myring
3113 description "My local buffer"
3114 format rfc3164
3115 maxlen 1200
3116 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003117 timeout connect 5s
3118 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003119 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003120
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020031213.10. Log forwarding
3122-------------------
3123
3124It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
3125haproxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
3126
3127log-forward <name>
3128 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3129
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003130backlog <conns>
3131 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3132 on connections accept.
3133
3134bind <addr> [param*]
3135 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003136 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3137 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3138 syslog protocol over TCP.
3139 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003140 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3141
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003142dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003143 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3144 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3145 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3146 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003147 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003148
3149log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003150log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003151 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3152 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3153 documentation.
3154 If no format specified, haproxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
3155 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3156 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3157 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
3158 exists in output format, haproxy will use the local date.
3159
3160 Example:
3161 global
3162 log stderr format iso local7
3163
3164 ring myring
3165 description "My local buffer"
3166 format rfc5424
3167 maxlen 1200
3168 size 32764
3169 timeout connect 5s
3170 timeout server 10s
3171 # syslog tcp server
3172 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3173
3174 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003175 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3176 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003177 # all messages on stderr
3178 log global
3179 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3180 log ring@myring local0
3181 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3182 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3183 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3184 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3185 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003186
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003187maxconn <conns>
3188 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3189 10 is the default.
3190
3191timeout client <timeout>
3192 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3193
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020031944. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003195----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003196
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003197Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003198 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
3199 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3200 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3201 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003202
3203A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3204connections.
3205
3206A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3207to forward incoming connections.
3208
3209A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3210parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3211
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003212A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
3213ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
3214sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
3215the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
3216explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
3217from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
3218"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
3219for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
3220to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
3221optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
3222are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
3223any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
3224names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
3225that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
3226duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
3227names. This rule might be enforced in a future version.
3228
3229Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
3230settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
3231of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
3232profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
3233timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
3234
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003235All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3236'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3237case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3238
3239Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3240logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3241proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3242However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3243name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3244
3245Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3246and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003247bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003248protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3249modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3250arbitrary criteria.
3251
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003252In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3253a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003254the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003255
3256 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3257 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3258 between responses and new requests.
3259
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003260 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3261 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3262 client-facing connection remains open.
3263
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003264 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3265 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003266
3267The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3268frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3269following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003270weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003271
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003272 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003273
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003274 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3275 ----+-----+-----+----
3276 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3277 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003278 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3279 ----+-----+-----+----
3280 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003281
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003282
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003283
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020032844.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3285--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003286
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003287The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3288limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3289they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3290limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003291marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003292option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003293and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3294with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3295specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003296
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003297
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003298 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3299------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3300acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003301backlog X X X -
3302balance X - X X
3303bind - X X -
3304bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003305capture cookie - X X -
3306capture request header - X X -
3307capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003308clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3309clitcpka-idle X X X -
3310clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003311compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003312cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003313declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003314default-server X - X X
3315default_backend X X X -
3316description - X X X
3317disabled X X X X
3318dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003319email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003320email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003321email-alert mailers X X X X
3322email-alert myhostname X X X X
3323email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003324enabled X X X X
3325errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003326errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003327errorloc X X X X
3328errorloc302 X X X X
3329-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3330errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003331force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003332filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003333fullconn X - X X
3334grace X X X X
3335hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003336http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003337http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003338http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003339http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003340http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003341http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003342http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003343http-check set-var X - X X
3344http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003345http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003346http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003347http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003348http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003349http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003350id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003351ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003352load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003353log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003354log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003355log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003356log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003357max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003358maxconn X X X -
3359mode X X X X
3360monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003361monitor-uri X X X -
3362option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3363option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3364option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3365option allbackups (*) X - X X
3366option checkcache (*) X - X X
3367option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3368option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003369option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003370option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3371option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003372-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3373option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003374option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3375option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003376option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003377option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003378option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003379option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003380option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003381option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3382option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3383option httpchk X - X X
3384option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003385option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003386option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003387option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003388option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003389option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003390option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3391option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3392option logasap (*) X X X -
3393option mysql-check X - X X
3394option nolinger (*) X X X X
3395option originalto X X X X
3396option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003397option pgsql-check X - X X
3398option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003399option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003400option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003401option smtpchk X - X X
3402option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3403option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3404option splice-request (*) X X X X
3405option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003406option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003407option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3408option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3409-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003410option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003411option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3412option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3413option tcpka X X X X
3414option tcplog X X X X
3415option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003416external-check command X - X X
3417external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003418persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3419rate-limit sessions X X X -
3420redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003421-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003422retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003423retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003424server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003425server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003426server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003427source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003428srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3429srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3430srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003431stats admin - X X X
3432stats auth X X X X
3433stats enable X X X X
3434stats hide-version X X X X
3435stats http-request - X X X
3436stats realm X X X X
3437stats refresh X X X X
3438stats scope X X X X
3439stats show-desc X X X X
3440stats show-legends X X X X
3441stats show-node X X X X
3442stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003443-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3444stick match - - X X
3445stick on - - X X
3446stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003447stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003448stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003449tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003450tcp-check connect X - X X
3451tcp-check expect X - X X
3452tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003453tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003454tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003455tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003456tcp-check set-var X - X X
3457tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003458tcp-request connection - X X -
3459tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003460tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003461tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003462tcp-response content - - X X
3463tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003464timeout check X - X X
3465timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003466timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003467timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003468timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3469timeout http-request X X X X
3470timeout queue X - X X
3471timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003472timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003473timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003474timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003475transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003476unique-id-format X X X -
3477unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003478use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003479use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003480use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003481------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3482 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003483
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003484
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020034854.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3486---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003487
3488This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3489
3490
3491acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3492 Declare or complete an access list.
3493 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3494 no | yes | yes | yes
3495 Example:
3496 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3497 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3498 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3499
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003500 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003501
3502
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003503backlog <conns>
3504 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3505 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3506 yes | yes | yes | no
3507 Arguments :
3508 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3509 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003510 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003511
3512 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3513 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3514 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3515 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3516 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3517 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3518 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3519 backlog parameter.
3520
3521 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3522 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3523 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3524
3525 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3526
3527
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003528balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003529balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003530 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3531 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3532 yes | no | yes | yes
3533 Arguments :
3534 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3535 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3536 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3537 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3538
3539 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3540 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3541 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3542 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003543 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003544 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003545 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3546 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3547 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3548 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3549 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3550 it, so that you don't worry.
3551
3552 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3553 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3554 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3555 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3556 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3557 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3558 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3559 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003560
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003561 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3562 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3563 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3564 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3565 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3566 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3567 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003568 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3569 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3570 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003571
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003572 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003573 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003574 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3575 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003576 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003577 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3578 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3579 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3580 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3581 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003582 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3583 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3584 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3585 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3586 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3587 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003588
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003589 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3590 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3591 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3592 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3593 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3594 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3595 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3596 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003597 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003598 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003599 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3600 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3601 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003602
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003603 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3604 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3605 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3606 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3607 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3608 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3609 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3610 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3611 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3612 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3613 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3614 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003615
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003616 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003617 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3618 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3619 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3620 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3621 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3622 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3623 URIs start with a leading "/".
3624
3625 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3626 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3627 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3628 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3629
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003630 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3631 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3632 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3633 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3634
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003635 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003636 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3637
3638 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003639 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3640 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003641 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3642 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3643 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3644 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003645 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003646 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3647 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003648
3649 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3650 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3651 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3652 server will receive the request.
3653
3654 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3655 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3656 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3657 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3658 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003659 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3660 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3661 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003662
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003663 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3664 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3665 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3666 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3667 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003668
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003669 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003670 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3671 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3672 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3673
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003674 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3675 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3676 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3677
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003678 random
3679 random(<draws>)
3680 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003681 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3682 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3683 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3684 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003685 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3686 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3687 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3688 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3689 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3690 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3691 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3692 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3693 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3694 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3695 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3696 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3697 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3698 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3699 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3700 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3701 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3702 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3703 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3704 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003705
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003706 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003707 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003708 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3709 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3710 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3711 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3712 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3713 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003714 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003715 used instead.
3716
3717 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3718 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3719 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3720 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3721
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003722 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3723 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3724 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3725
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003726 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003727
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003728 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003729 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3730 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003731
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003732 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3733 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3734 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003735
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003736 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003737 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003738 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3739 NTLM relies on.
3740
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003741 Examples :
3742 balance roundrobin
3743 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003744 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003745 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3746 balance hdr(host)
3747 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003748
3749 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3750 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3751
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003752 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003753 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3754 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3755 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003756 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003757
3758 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3759 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3760 defaults to 16 kB.
3761
3762 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3763 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3764
3765 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3766 Round Robin.
3767
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003768 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003769 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3770 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3771 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3772
3773 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3774
3775 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003776 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003777 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3778 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3779 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003780
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003781 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003782
3783
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003784bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3785bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003786 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3787 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3788 no | yes | yes | no
3789 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003790 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3791 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3792 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3793 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003794 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003795 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3796 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3797 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3798 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3799 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3800 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003801 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003802 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
3803 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003804 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003805 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3806 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003807 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003808 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3809 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003810 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003811 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3812 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3813 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3814 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3815 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3816 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3817 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003818 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3819 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3820 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003821 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3822 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3823 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3824 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003825 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3826 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3827 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003828
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003829 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3830 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003831 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3832 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3833 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003834 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3835 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3836 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3837 the range.
3838
3839 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3840 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3841 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3842 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3843 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3844 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3845 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003846 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003847 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003848
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003849 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003850 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003851 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3852 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3853 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3854 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3855 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3856 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3857
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003858 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3859 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3860 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3861 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003862
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003863 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3864 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3865 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3866 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3867 in a frontend.
3868
3869 Example :
3870 listen http_proxy
3871 bind :80,:443
3872 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003873 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003874
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003875 listen http_https_proxy
3876 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003877 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003878
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003879 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3880 bind ipv6@:80
3881 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3882 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3883
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003884 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003885 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003886
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003887 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3888 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3889 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3890 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3891 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3892
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003893 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003894 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003895
3896
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003897bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003898 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3899 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3900 yes | yes | yes | yes
3901 Arguments :
3902 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3903 may be used to override a default value.
3904
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003905 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003906 option may be combined with other numbers.
3907
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003908 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003909 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3910 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3911 missing from all processes.
3912
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003913 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003914 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003915 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3916 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3917 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3918 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3919 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003920 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003921
3922 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3923 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3924 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3925 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3926 and 'even' instances.
3927
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003928 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3929 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3930 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3931 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003932
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003933 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3934 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3935
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003936 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3937 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3938 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3939
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003940 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3941 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3942
3943 Example :
3944 listen app_ip1
3945 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003946 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003947
3948 listen app_ip2
3949 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003950 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003951
3952 listen management
3953 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003954 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003955
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003956 listen management
3957 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3958 bind-process 1-4
3959
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003960 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003961
3962
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003963capture cookie <name> len <length>
3964 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3965 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3966 no | yes | yes | no
3967 Arguments :
3968 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3969 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3970 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3971 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003972 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003973
3974 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3975 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3976 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3977 right if it exceeds <length>.
3978
3979 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3980 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3981 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3982 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3983
3984 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3985 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3986 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3987
3988 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3989 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3990 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003991 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3992 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3993 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003994
3995 Example:
3996 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3997
3998 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003999 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004000
4001
4002capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004003 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004004 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4005 no | yes | yes | no
4006 Arguments :
4007 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004008 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004009 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4010 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4011 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4012
4013 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4014 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4015 it exceeds <length>.
4016
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004017 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004018 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4019 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004020 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4021 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4022 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4023 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004024 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004025 environments to find where the request came from.
4026
4027 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4028 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4029 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4030 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004031
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004032 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4033 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4034 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4035 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4036 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004037
4038 Example:
4039 capture request header Host len 15
4040 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004041 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004042
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004043 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004044 about logging.
4045
4046
4047capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004048 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004049 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4050 no | yes | yes | no
4051 Arguments :
4052 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004053 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004054 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4055 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4056 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4057
4058 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4059 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4060 it exceeds <length>.
4061
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004062 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004063 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4064 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4065 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004066 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4067 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4068 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4069 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004070
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004071 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4072 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4073 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4074 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4075 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004076
4077 Example:
4078 capture response header Content-length len 9
4079 capture response header Location len 15
4080
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004081 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004082 about logging.
4083
4084
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004085clitcpka-cnt <count>
4086 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4087 the connection on the client side.
4088 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4089 yes | yes | yes | no
4090 Arguments :
4091 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4092
4093 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4094 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004095 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4096 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004097
4098 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4099
4100
4101clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4102 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4103 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4104 client side.
4105 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4106 yes | yes | yes | no
4107 Arguments :
4108 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4109 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4110 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4111 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4112
4113 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4114 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004115 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4116 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004117
4118 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4119
4120
4121clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4122 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4123 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4124 yes | yes | yes | no
4125 Arguments :
4126 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4127 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4128 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4129 document.
4130
4131 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4132 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004133 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4134 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004135
4136 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4137
4138
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004139compression algo <algorithm> ...
4140compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004141compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004142 Enable HTTP compression.
4143 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4144 yes | yes | yes | yes
4145 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004146 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4147 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
4148 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
4149
4150 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004151 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4152 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4153 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004154
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004155 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004156 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004157
4158 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4159 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4160 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4161 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4162 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004163 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004164
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004165 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4166 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4167 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4168 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4169 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4170 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4171 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004172 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004173
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004174 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004175 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004176 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
4177 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
4178 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
4179 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
4180 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004181
4182 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
4183 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4184 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
4185 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
4186 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004187 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
4188 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
4189 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4190 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
4191 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004192 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4193 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004194
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004195 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004196 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4197 "Accept-Encoding" header
4198 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004199 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004200 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4201 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4202 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4203 "multipart"
4204 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4205 header
4206 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4207 and later
4208 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4209 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004210 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004211
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004212 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004213
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004214 Examples :
4215 compression algo gzip
4216 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004217
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004218
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004219cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004220 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4221 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004222 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004223 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4224 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4225 yes | no | yes | yes
4226 Arguments :
4227 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4228 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4229 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4230 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4231 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4232 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004233 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004234 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4235 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4236
4237 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
4238 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
4239 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4240 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4241 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4242 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004243 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4244 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004245 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004246 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4247 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004248
4249 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004250 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004251
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004252 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004253 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004254 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004255 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004256 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4257 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4258 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4259 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4260 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4261 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4262 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004263
4264 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4265 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4266 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4267 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4268 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4269 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4270 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4271 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4272 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004273 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004274 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4275 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4276 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004277
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004278 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4279 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4280 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004281 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4282 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4283 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4284 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004285 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4286 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4287 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004288
4289 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4290 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4291 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4292 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4293 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4294 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4295 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4296 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4297 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4298
4299 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4300 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4301 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4302 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4303 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4304 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4305 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4306 persistence cookie in the cache.
4307 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4308
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004309 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4310 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
4311 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
4312 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4313 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004314 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004315 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4316 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4317 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4318 they logout.
4319
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004320 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
4321 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4322 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4323 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4324
4325 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
4326 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4327 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4328 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4329 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4330 this attribute.
4331
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004332 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004333 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004334 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4335 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4336 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4337 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4338 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4339 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004340
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004341 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4342 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4343 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4344 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4345 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4346 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4347 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4348 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004349 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004350 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4351 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4352 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4353 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4354 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4355 the site.
4356
4357 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4358 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4359 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4360 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4361 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4362 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4363 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4364 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4365 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4366 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4367 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4368 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4369 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004370 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004371 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4372 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4373
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004374 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4375 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4376 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4377 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4378 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4379 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4380
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004381 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
4382 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4383 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4384 repeated.
4385
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004386 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4387 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4388 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4389 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004390
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004391 Examples :
4392 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4393 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4394 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004395 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004396
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004397 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004398
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004399
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004400declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4401 Declares a capture slot.
4402 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4403 no | yes | yes | no
4404 Arguments:
4405 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4406
4407 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4408 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4409 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4410 for use in the response.
4411
4412 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004413 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004414 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4415
4416
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004417default-server [param*]
4418 Change default options for a server in a backend
4419 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4420 yes | no | yes | yes
4421 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004422 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4423 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4424 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4425 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004426
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004427 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004428 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4429
4430 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004431
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004432
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004433default_backend <backend>
4434 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4435 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4436 yes | yes | yes | no
4437 Arguments :
4438 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4439
4440 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4441 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4442 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4443 will catch all undetermined requests.
4444
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004445 Example :
4446
4447 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4448 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4449 default_backend dynamic
4450
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004451 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004452
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004453
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004454description <string>
4455 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4456 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4457 no | yes | yes | yes
4458 Arguments : string
4459
4460 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4461 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4462 it describes.
4463 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4464
4465
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004466disabled
4467 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4468 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4469 yes | yes | yes | yes
4470 Arguments : none
4471
4472 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4473 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4474 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4475 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4476 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4477 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4478 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4479
4480 See also : "enabled"
4481
4482
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004483dispatch <address>:<port>
4484 Set a default server address
4485 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4486 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004487 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004488
4489 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4490 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4491 during start-up.
4492
4493 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4494 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4495 possible with normal servers.
4496
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004497 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004498 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4499 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4500 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4501 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4502
4503 See also : "server"
4504
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004505
4506dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4507 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4508 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4509 yes | no | yes | yes
4510 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4511
4512 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004513 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004514 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4515 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004516 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004517 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004518
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004519enabled
4520 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4522 yes | yes | yes | yes
4523 Arguments : none
4524
4525 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4526 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4527
4528 See also : "disabled"
4529
4530
4531errorfile <code> <file>
4532 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4533 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4534 yes | yes | yes | yes
4535 Arguments :
4536 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004537 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004538 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004539
4540 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004541 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004542 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004543 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4544 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004545
4546 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4547 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4548 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4549
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004550 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4551
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004552 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4553 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4554 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4555 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4556 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4557 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4558 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4559 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4560 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004561
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004562 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4563 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4564 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004565 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004566 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4567
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004568 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004569
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004570 Example :
4571 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004572 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004573 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4574 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4575
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004576
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004577errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4578 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4579 section.
4580 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4581 yes | yes | yes | yes
4582 Arguments :
4583 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4584
4585 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004586 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004587 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
4588 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004589
4590 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4591 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4592 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4593 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4594 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004595 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004596 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4597
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004598 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4599 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004600
4601 Example :
4602 errorfiles generic
4603 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4604
4605
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004606errorloc <code> <url>
4607errorloc302 <code> <url>
4608 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4609 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4610 yes | yes | yes | yes
4611 Arguments :
4612 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004613 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004614 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004615
4616 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4617 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4618 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4619 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004620 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004621
4622 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4623 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4624 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4625
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004626 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4627
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004628 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4629 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4630 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4631 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004632 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004633 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4634 request.
4635
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004636 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004637
4638
4639errorloc303 <code> <url>
4640 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4641 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4642 yes | yes | yes | yes
4643 Arguments :
4644 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004645 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004646 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004647
4648 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4649 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4650 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4651 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004652 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004653
4654 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4655 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4656 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4657
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004658 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4659
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004660 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4661 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4662 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4663 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004664 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004665
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004666 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004667
4668
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004669email-alert from <emailaddr>
4670 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004671 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004672 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4673 yes | yes | yes | yes
4674
4675 Arguments :
4676
4677 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4678
4679 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4680 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4681
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004682 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004683 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4684 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004685
4686
4687email-alert level <level>
4688 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4689 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4690 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4691 yes | yes | yes | yes
4692
4693 Arguments :
4694
4695 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4696 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4697 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4698
4699 By default level is alert
4700
4701 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4702 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4703 for the proxy.
4704
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004705 Alerts are sent when :
4706
4707 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4708 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4709 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4710 is notice or lower
4711 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4712 and a health check status update occurs
4713
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004714 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4715 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004716 section 3.6 about mailers.
4717
4718
4719email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4720 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4721 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4722 yes | yes | yes | yes
4723
4724 Arguments :
4725
4726 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4727
4728 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4729 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4730
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004731 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4732 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004733
4734
4735email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4736 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4737 mailers.
4738 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4739 yes | yes | yes | yes
4740
4741 Arguments :
4742
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004743 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004744
4745 By default the systems hostname is used.
4746
4747 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4748 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4749 for the proxy.
4750
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004751 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4752 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004753
4754
4755email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004756 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004757 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4758 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4759 yes | yes | yes | yes
4760
4761 Arguments :
4762
4763 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4764
4765 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4766 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4767
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004768 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004769 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4770
4771
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004772force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4773 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4774 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004775 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004776
4777 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4778 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4779 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4780 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4781 marked down for maintenance operations.
4782
4783 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4784 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4785 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4786 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4787 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4788 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4789 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4790 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4791 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4792
4793 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4794 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4795 is used.
4796
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004797 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004798 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004799
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004800
4801filter <name> [param*]
4802 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4803 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4804 no | yes | yes | yes
4805 Arguments :
4806 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4807 referenced in section 9.
4808
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004809 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004810 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004811 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4812 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004813
4814 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4815 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4816
4817 Example:
4818 listen
4819 bind *:80
4820
4821 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4822 filter compression
4823 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4824
4825 compression algo gzip
4826 compression offload
4827
4828 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4829
4830 See also : section 9.
4831
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004832
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004833fullconn <conns>
4834 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4835 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4836 yes | no | yes | yes
4837 Arguments :
4838 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4839 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4840
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004841 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004842 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004843 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004844 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4845 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4846 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4847 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4848 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004849 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004850
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004851 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4852 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004853 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4854 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4855 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004856
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004857 Example :
4858 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4859 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4860 # connections.
4861 backend dynamic
4862 fullconn 10000
4863 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4864 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4865
4866 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4867
4868
Willy Tarreauab0a5192020-10-09 19:07:01 +02004869grace <time> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004870 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4871 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004872 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004873 Arguments :
4874 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4875 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4876 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4877
4878 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4879 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004880 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004881 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4882
4883 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4884 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4885 simplify it.
4886
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004887
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004888hash-balance-factor <factor>
4889 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4890 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4891 yes | no | no | yes
4892 Arguments :
4893 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4894 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004895 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004896
4897 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4898 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4899 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4900 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4901 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4902 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4903 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4904
4905 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4906 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4907 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4908 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4909 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4910
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004911 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4912 consistent hashing mechanism.
4913
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004914 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4915
4916
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004917hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004918 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4920 yes | no | yes | yes
4921 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004922 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4923 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004924
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004925 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4926 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4927 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4928 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4929 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4930 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4931 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4932 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4933 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4934 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004935
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004936 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4937 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4938 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4939 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4940 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4941 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4942 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4943 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4944 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4945 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4946 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4947 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4948 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004949 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4950 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004951
4952 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4953
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004954 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004955 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4956 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4957 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004958 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4959 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4960 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004961
4962 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4963 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004964 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4965 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4966 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4967 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4968
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004969 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4970 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4971 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4972 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4973 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4974 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4975 parameter.
4976
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004977 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4978 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4979 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4980 used on strings.
4981
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004982 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4983
4984 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4985 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4986 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4987 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4988 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4989 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4990 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4991 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4992 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4993 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4994 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4995 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004996
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004997 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4998 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4999 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005000
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005001 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005002
5003
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005004http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5005 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5006 ones).
5007
5008 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5009 no | yes | yes | yes
5010
5011 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5012 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5013 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5014 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5015 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5016 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5017
5018 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5019 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5020 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5021
5022 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5023 below.
5024
5025 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5026 instance.
5027
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005028 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5029 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5030 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5031
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005032 Example:
5033 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5034 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5035 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5036
5037http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5038
5039 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5040 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5041 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5042 example, or to pass some internal information.
5043 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5044 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5045 the resulting header from a previous rule.
5046
5047http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5048
5049 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5050 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
5051
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005052http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005053
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005054 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5055 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5056 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5057 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5058 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005059
5060http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5061 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5062
5063 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5064
5065 Example:
5066 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5067
5068 # applied to:
5069 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5070
5071 # outputs:
5072 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5073
5074 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5075
5076http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5077 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5078
5079 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5080
5081 Example:
5082 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5083
5084 # applied to:
5085 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5086
5087 # outputs:
5088 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5089
5090http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5091
5092 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5093 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5094 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
5095
5096http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5097 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5098
5099 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5100 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5101 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5102 fallback.
5103
5104 Example:
5105 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5106 http-response set-status 431
5107 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5108 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
5109
5110http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5111
5112 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5113 inline.
5114
5115 Arguments:
5116 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5117 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5118 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5119 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5120 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5121 (request and response)
5122 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5123 processing
5124 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5125 processing
5126 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5127 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5128 and '_'.
5129
5130 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5131 followed by some converters.
5132
5133 Example:
5134 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5135
5136http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5137
5138 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5139 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5140 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5141 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5142 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005143 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005144 processing.
5145
5146 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5147 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005148 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005149 rules evaluation.
5150
5151http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5152
5153 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5154 details about <var-name>.
5155
5156 Example:
5157 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5158
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005159
5160http-check comment <string>
5161 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5162 it fails.
5163 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5164 yes | no | yes | yes
5165
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005166 Arguments :
5167 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5168 rule fails.
5169
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005170 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5171 user-friendly error reporting.
5172
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005173 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005174 "http-check expect".
5175
5176
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005177http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5178 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005179 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005180 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5181 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5182 yes | no | yes | yes
5183
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005184 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005185 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5186
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005187 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005188 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005189
5190 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5191 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5192 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5193 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5194
5195 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5196
5197 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5198
5199 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5200
5201 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5202
5203 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5204
5205 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5206 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5207 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5208 is used.
5209
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005210 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5211 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5212 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5213 haproxy -vv.
5214
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005215 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5216
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005217 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5218 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5219 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5220 different ports or with different servers.
5221
5222 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5223 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5224 the port with a "http-check connect".
5225
5226 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5227 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5228 do.
5229
5230 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5231 unset-var or comment rules.
5232
5233 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005234 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5235 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5236 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5237 option httpchk
5238
5239 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005240 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005241 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005242 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005243 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005244 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005245
5246 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5247
5248 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005249
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005250
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005251http-check disable-on-404
5252 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5253 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005254 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005255 Arguments : none
5256
5257 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5258 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5259 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5260 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5261 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5262 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5263 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5264 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005265 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5266 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005267 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5268 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5269 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005270
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005271 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005272
5273
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005274http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005275 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5276 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5277 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005278 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005279 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005280 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005281
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005282 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005283 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5284
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005285 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5286 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5287 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5288 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5289 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5290 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5291 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5292 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5293 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5294 result is always conclusive.
5295
5296 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5297 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5298 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005299 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5300 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005301 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5302 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005303 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5304 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5305 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005306
5307 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5308 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005309 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5310 supported :
5311 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5312 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005313 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5314 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5315 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5316 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5317 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005318
5319 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5320 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005321 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5322 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5323 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5324 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005325 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5326
5327 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5328 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5329 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5330 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5331
5332 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5333 informational message reported in logs if an error
5334 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5335 log-format string.
5336
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005337 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005338 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5339 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005340 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5341 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5342 details on the supported keywords.
5343
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005344 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5345 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5346 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5347 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005348
5349 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5350 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5351 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5352 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5353 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5354
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005355 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5356 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5357 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5358 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5359 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5360 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5361 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005362
5363 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005364 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005365 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5366 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5367 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5368 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5369
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005370 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5371 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005372 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5373 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5374 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5375 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5376 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5377 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5378 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5379 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005380 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5381 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5382 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5383 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5384 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5385 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5386 insensitive on the header names.
5387
5388 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5389 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5390 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5391 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5392 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5393 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005394
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005395 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005396 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005397 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5398 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5399 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5400 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5401 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005402 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005403 trace).
5404
5405 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005406 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005407 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5408 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5409 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5410 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5411 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005412 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005413
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005414 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5415 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5416 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5417 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5418 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5419 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5420
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005421 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005422 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005423 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5424 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5425 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5426 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5427 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5428 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5429
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005430 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5431 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5432 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5433 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5434 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005435
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005436 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5437 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5438
5439 Examples :
5440 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005441 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005442
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005443 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5444 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5445
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005446 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005447 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005448
5449 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005450 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005451
5452 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005453 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005454
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005455 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005456 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005457
5458
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005459http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005460 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5461 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005462 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5463 health checks.
5464 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5465 yes | no | yes | yes
5466 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005467 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5468
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005469 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5470 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5471 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5472 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5473 to invent non-standard ones.
5474
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005475 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5476 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5477 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5478 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5479
5480 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5481 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5482 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5483 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005484
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005485 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005486 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005487 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005488 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5489 to add it.
5490
5491 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5492 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5493 to the log-format rules.
5494
5495 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5496 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5497 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005498
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005499 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5500 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5501 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5502 request.
5503
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005504 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5505 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5506 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005507 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5508 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5509 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5510 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005511 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005512
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005513 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005514 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
5515 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005516
5517 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5518 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5519 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5520 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5521 configured request authority.
5522
5523 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5524 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005525
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005526 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005527
5528
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005529http-check send-state
5530 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5531 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5532 yes | no | yes | yes
5533 Arguments : none
5534
5535 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
5536 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
5537 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5538 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
5539 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
5540
5541 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5542 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5543 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5544 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5545 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005546 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5547 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5548 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5549
5550 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5551 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5552 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5553
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005554 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5555 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5556 checked in multiple backends.
5557
5558 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
5559 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5560
5561 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5562 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5563 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5564 one fails.
5565
5566 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5567 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5568 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5569
5570 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5571 server's queue.
5572
5573 Example of a header received by the application server :
5574 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5575 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5576
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005577 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5578 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005579
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005580
5581http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005582 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005583 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5584 yes | no | yes | yes
5585
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005586 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005587 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5588 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5589 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5590 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5591 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5592 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5593 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5594 and '-'.
5595
5596 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5597
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005598 Examples :
5599 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005600
5601
5602http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005603 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005604 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5605 yes | no | yes | yes
5606
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005607 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005608 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5609 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5610 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5611 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5612 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5613 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5614 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5615 and '-'.
5616
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005617 Examples :
5618 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005619
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005620
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005621http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5622 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5623 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5624 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5625 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5626 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5627 yes | yes | yes | yes
5628 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005629 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005630 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005631 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005632 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005633
5634 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5635 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5636 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5637 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5638
5639 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5640 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5641 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5642 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5643
5644 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5645 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5646 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5647 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5648 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5649 chroot is performed.
5650
5651 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5652 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5653 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5654 considered.
5655
5656 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5657 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5658 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5659 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5660 considered as a raw string.
5661
5662 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5663 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5664 "content-type".
5665
5666 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5667 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5668 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5669 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5670 evaluated as a log-format string.
5671
5672 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5673 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5674 argument to "content-type".
5675
5676 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5677 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5678 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5679 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5680
5681 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5682 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5683 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5684 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5685 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5686 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5687 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5688 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5689
5690 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5691 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5692 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5693
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005694 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
5695 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
5696 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
5697 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
5698 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
5699
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005700 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5701 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5702
5703
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005704http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005705 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5706
5707 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5708 no | yes | yes | yes
5709
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005710 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5711 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5712 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5713 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5714 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005715
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005716 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5717 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005718
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005719 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005720
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005721 Example:
5722 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5723 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5724 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005725
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005726 http-request allow if nagios
5727 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5728 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5729 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005730
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005731 Example:
5732 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5733 acl add path /addacl
5734 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005735
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005736 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005737
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005738 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5739 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005740
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005741 Example:
5742 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5743 acl setmap path /setmap
5744 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005745
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005746 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005747
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005748 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5749 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005750
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005751 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5752 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005753
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005754http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005755
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005756 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5757 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5758 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5759 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5760 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5761 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5762 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5763 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005764
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005765http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005766
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005767 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
5768 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
5769 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
5770 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
5771 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
5772 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
5773 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
5774 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005775
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005776http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005777
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005778 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
5779 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005780
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005781
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005782http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005783
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005784 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
5785 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
5786 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
5787 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
5788 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005789
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005790 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
5791 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
5792 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
5793 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
5794 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
5795 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
5796 instead.
5797
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005798 Example:
5799 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
5800 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005801
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005802http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005803
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005804 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005805
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005806http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
5807 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005808
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005809 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
5810 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
5811 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
5812 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
5813 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
5814 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
5815 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
5816 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
5817 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005818
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005819 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
5820 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
5821 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005822 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
5823
5824 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5825 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5826 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5827 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005828
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005829http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005830
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005831 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5832 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5833 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5834 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5835 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5836 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005837
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005838http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005839
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005840 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5841 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5842 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5843 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5844 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005845
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005846http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005847
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005848 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5849 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5850 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5851 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5852 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5853 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005854
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005855http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5856http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
5857 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5858 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5859 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5860 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005861
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005862 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
5863 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
5864 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005865 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005866 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
5867 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
5868 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005869 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005870 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005871
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02005872http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5873 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
5874 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
5875 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
5876
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01005877http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
5878
5879 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
5880 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
5881 pointed by <resolvers>.
5882 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
5883 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
5884 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
5885 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
5886 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
5887 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
5888 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
5889 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
5890 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
5891 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
5892 to 0.0.0.0.
5893
5894 Example:
5895 resolvers mydns
5896 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
5897 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
5898 timeout retry 1s
5899 hold valid 10s
5900 hold nx 3s
5901 hold other 3s
5902 hold obsolete 0s
5903 accepted_payload_size 8192
5904
5905 frontend fe
5906 bind 10.42.0.1:80
5907 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
5908 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
5909
5910 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
5911 # which mean DNS resolution error
5912 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
5913
5914 default_backend be
5915
5916 backend b_503
5917 # dummy backend used to return 503.
5918 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
5919 # 503 error page to end users
5920
5921 backend be
5922 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
5923 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
5924 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
5925 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
5926 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
5927
5928 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
5929 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
5930
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005931http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5932
5933 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
5934 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
5935 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
5936 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01005937 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
5938 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005939
5940 See RFC 8297 for more information.
5941
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005942http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005943
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005944 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
5945 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
5946 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
5947 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
5948 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005949
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005950http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005951
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005952 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
5953 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
5954 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
5955 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005956
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005957http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5958 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02005959
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005960 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005961 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
5962 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
5963 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
5964 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
5965 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02005966
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005967 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
5968 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
5969 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
5970 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
5971 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005972
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005973 Example:
5974 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
5975
5976 # applied to:
5977 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5978
5979 # outputs:
5980 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5981
5982 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005983
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005984 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
5985
5986 # applied to:
5987 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005988
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005989 # outputs:
5990 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005991
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005992http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5993 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5994
5995 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
5996 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02005997 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
5998 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
5999 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006000
6001 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6002 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6003 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
6004
6005 Example:
6006 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6007 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
6008
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006009 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
6010 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
6011 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
6012 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
6013
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006014http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6015 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6016
6017 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
6018 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
6019 query-string are replaced.
6020
6021 Example:
6022 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
6023 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
6024
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006025http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6026 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6027
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006028 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
6029 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
6030 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
6031 against.
6032
6033 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6034 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6035 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006036
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006037 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
6038 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
6039 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
6040 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
6041 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
6042 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
6043 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
6044 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
6045 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006046 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
6047 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006048
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006049 Example:
6050 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
6051 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006052
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006053 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6054 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006055
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006056http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6057 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006058
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006059 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
6060 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
6061 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
6062 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006063
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006064 Example:
6065 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006066
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006067 # applied to:
6068 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006069
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006070 # outputs:
6071 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006072
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006073http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6074 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6075 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006076 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006077 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6078
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006079 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006080 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6081 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006082 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006083 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006084 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006085 are followed to create the response :
6086
6087 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6088 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6089 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6090 ignored.
6091
6092 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6093 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006094 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006095 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6096 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006097
6098 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6099 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6100 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006101 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
6102 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006103
6104 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6105 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6106 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006107 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006108 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006109 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006110
6111 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6112 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6113 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6114 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6115 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6116 as a raw content.
6117
6118 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6119 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6120 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6121 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6122 considered as a raw string.
6123
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006124 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006125 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6126 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6127 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6128
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006129 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6130 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006131 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006132
6133 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6134
6135 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006136 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006137 if { path /ping }
6138
6139 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6140 if { path /favicon.ico }
6141
6142 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6143 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6144 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6145
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006146http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6147http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006148
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006149 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6150 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6151 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006152
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006153http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6154 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006155
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006156 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6157 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6158 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6159 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006160
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006161http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006162
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006163 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6164 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6165 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6166 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6167 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006168
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006169 Arguments:
6170 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6171 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006172
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006173 Example:
6174 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6175 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006176
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006177 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6178 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006179
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006180http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006181
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006182 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6183 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6184 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006185
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006186 Arguments:
6187 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6188 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006189
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006190 Example:
6191 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6192 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006193
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006194 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6195 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6196 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006197
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006198http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006199
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006200 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6201 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6202 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6203 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6204 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006205
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006206 Example:
6207 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6208 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6209 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6210 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6211 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6212 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6213 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6214 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6215 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006216
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006217http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006218
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006219 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6220 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6221 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6222 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6223 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006224
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006225http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6226 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006227
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006228 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6229 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6230 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6231 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6232 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6233 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6234 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6235 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6236 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006237
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006238http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006239
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006240 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6241 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6242 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6243 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
6244 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
6245 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
6246 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006247
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006248http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006249
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006250 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6251 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6252 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006253
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006254http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006255
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006256 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6257 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6258 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6259 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6260 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6261 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6262 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6263 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006264
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006265http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006266
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006267 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6268 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6269 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6270 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6271 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6272 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006273
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006274 Example :
6275 # prepend the host name before the path
6276 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006277
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006278http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6279
6280 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6281 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6282 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6283
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006284http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006285
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006286 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6287 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6288 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6289 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6290 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006291
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006292http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006293
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006294 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6295 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6296 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6297 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6298 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6299 values have higher priority.
6300 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6301 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6302 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6303 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6304 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006305
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006306http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006307
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006308 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6309 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6310 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6311 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6312 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6313 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6314 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006315
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006316 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006317
6318 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006319 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6320 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006321
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006322http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6323 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6324 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6325 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006326 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6327 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006328
6329 Arguments :
6330 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6331 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006332
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006333 See also "option forwardfor".
6334
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006335 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006336 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6337 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6338
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006339 # After the masking this will track connections
6340 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6341 http-request track-sc0 src
6342
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006343 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6344 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6345
6346http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6347
6348 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6349 expression.
6350
6351 Arguments:
6352 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6353 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006354
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006355 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006356 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6357 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6358
6359 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6360 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6361 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6362
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006363http-request set-timeout server|tunnel { <timeout> | <expr> }
6364 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6365
6366 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
6367 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
6368 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
6369 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
6370 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
6371
6372 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
6373 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
6374 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
6375 results.
6376
6377 Example:
6378 http-request set-timeout server 5s
6379 http-request set-timeout hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
6380
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006381http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6382
6383 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6384 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6385 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6386 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6387 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6388 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6389 information from the request.
6390
6391 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6392
6393http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6394
6395 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6396 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
6397 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
6398 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
6399 path and the query string.
6400 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6401
6402http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6403
6404 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6405 inline.
6406
6407 Arguments:
6408 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6409 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6410 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6411 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6412 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6413 (request and response)
6414 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6415 processing
6416 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6417 processing
6418 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6419 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6420 and '_'.
6421
6422 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6423 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006424
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006425 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006426 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006427
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006428http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6429 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006430
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006431 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6432 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6433 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6434 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6435 agent name must be used.
6436
6437 Arguments:
6438 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6439
6440 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6441 configuration.
6442
6443http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6444
6445 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6446 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6447 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6448 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6449 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6450 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6451 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6452 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6453 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6454 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6455 action.
6456 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6457 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6458 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6459 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6460 you fully understand how it works.
6461
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006462http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6463
6464 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6465 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6466 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6467 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6468 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006469 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006470 processing.
6471
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006472 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006473 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6474 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6475 rules evaluation.
6476
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006477http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6478http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6479 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6480 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6481 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6482 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006483
6484 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6485 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6486 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006487 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6488 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6489 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6490 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6491 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6492 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
6493 things worse by forcing haproxy and the front firewall to support insane
6494 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6495 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6496 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006497 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006498 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6499 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6500 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6501 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6502 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006503
6504http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6505http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6506http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6507
6508 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6509 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6510 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6511 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006512 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006513 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6514 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6515 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6516 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6517 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6518 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6519 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6520
6521 Arguments :
6522 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6523 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6524 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6525 select which table entry to update the counters.
6526
6527 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6528 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6529 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6530 that table until the session ends.
6531
6532 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6533 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6534 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6535 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6536 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6537 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6538 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6539 useful information.
6540
6541 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6542 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6543 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6544 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6545 checks that make use of it.
6546
6547http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6548
6549 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006550
6551 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006552 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006553
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006554http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6555
6556 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6557 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6558 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6559 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6560 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6561 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6562
6563 Arguments :
6564 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6565
6566 Example:
6567 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6568
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006569http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006570
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006571 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
6572 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
6573 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006574
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006575
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006576http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006577 Access control for Layer 7 responses
6578
6579 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6580 no | yes | yes | yes
6581
6582 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6583 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6584 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6585 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6586 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
6587 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
6588
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006589 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
6590 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006591
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006592 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006593
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006594 Example:
6595 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006596
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006597 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006598
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006599 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
6600 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006601
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006602 Example:
6603 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006604
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006605 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006606
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006607 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
6608 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006609
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006610 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6611 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006612
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006613http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006614
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006615 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6616 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6617 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6618 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6619 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6620 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6621 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6622 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006623
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006624http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006625
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006626 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
6627 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
6628 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
6629 example, or to pass some internal information.
6630 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
6631 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
6632 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006633
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006634http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006635
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006636 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
6637 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006638
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006639http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006640
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006641 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006642
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006643http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006644
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006645 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
6646 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
6647 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
6648 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
6649 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
6650 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
6651 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006652
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006653 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
6654 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
6655 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
6656 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
6657 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006658
6659 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6660 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6661 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6662 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006663
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006664http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006665
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006666 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6667 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6668 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6669 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6670 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6671 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006672
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006673http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006674
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006675 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6676 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6677 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6678 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6679 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006680
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006681http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006682
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006683 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6684 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6685 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6686 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6687 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6688 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006689
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006690http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6691http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6692 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6693 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6694 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6695 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006696
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006697 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
6698 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6699 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006700 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006701 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
6702 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
6703 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01006704 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006705 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006706
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006707http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006708
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006709 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
6710 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
6711 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
6712 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
6713 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
6714 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006715
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006716http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6717 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006718
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006719 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
6720 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006721
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006722 Example:
6723 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02006724
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006725 # applied to:
6726 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006727
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006728 # outputs:
6729 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006730
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006731 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006732
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006733http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6734 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006735
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01006736 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006737 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006738
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006739 Example:
6740 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006741
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006742 # applied to:
6743 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006744
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006745 # outputs:
6746 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006747
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006748http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6749 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6750 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006751 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006752 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6753
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006754 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006755 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6756 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006757 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006758 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006759 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006760 are followed to create the response :
6761
6762 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6763 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6764 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6765 ignored.
6766
6767 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6768 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006769 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006770 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6771 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006772
6773 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6774 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6775 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006776 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
6777 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006778
6779 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6780 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6781 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006782 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006783 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006784 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006785
6786 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6787 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6788 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6789 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6790 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6791 as a raw content.
6792
6793 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6794 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6795 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6796 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6797 considered as a raw string.
6798
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006799 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
6800 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6801 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6802 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6803
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006804 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6805 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006806 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006807
6808 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
6809
6810 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006811 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006812 if { status eq 404 }
6813
6814 http-response return content-type text/plain \
6815 string "This is the end !" \
6816 if { status eq 500 }
6817
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006818http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6819http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08006820
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006821 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6822 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6823 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006824
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006825http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6826 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006827
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006828 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6829 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6830 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6831 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006832
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006833http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006834
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006835 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6836 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6837 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6838 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6839 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006840
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006841 Arguments:
6842 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006843
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006844 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6845 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006846
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006847http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006848
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006849 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
6850 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
6851 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006852
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006853http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6854
6855 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6856 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6857 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6858 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
6859 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
6860
6861http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6862
6863 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6864 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6865 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6866 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6867 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
6868 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6869 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6870 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
6871 be triggered by an HTTP response.
6872
6873http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6874
6875 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6876 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6877 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6878 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
6879 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
6880 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
6881 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
6882
6883http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6884
6885 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
6886 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
6887 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
6888 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
6889 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
6890 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6891 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6892 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
6893
6894http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
6895 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6896
6897 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
6898 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
6899 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
6900 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006901
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006902 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006903 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
6904 http-response set-status 431
6905 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
6906 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006907
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006908http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006909
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006910 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6911 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
6912 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
6913 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
6914 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
6915 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
6916 based on some information from the request.
6917
6918 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6919
6920http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6921
6922 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6923 inline.
6924
6925 Arguments:
6926 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6927 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6928 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6929 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6930 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6931 (request and response)
6932 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6933 processing
6934 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6935 processing
6936 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6937 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
6938 and '_'.
6939
6940 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6941 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006942
6943 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006944 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006945
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006946http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006947
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006948 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6949 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6950 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6951 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6952 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6953 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6954 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6955 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6956 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6957 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6958 action.
6959 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6960 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6961 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6962 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6963 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006964
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006965http-response strict-mode { on | off }
6966
6967 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6968 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6969 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6970 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6971 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006972 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006973 processing.
6974
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006975 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006976 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006977 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006978 rules evaluation.
6979
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006980http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6981http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6982http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006983
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006984 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
6985 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
6986 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
6987 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
6988 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
6989 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
6990
6991http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6992
6993 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
6994 about <var-name>.
6995
6996 Example:
6997 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
6998
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02006999
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007000http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
7001 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
7002
7003 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7004 yes | no | yes | yes
7005
7006 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007007 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
7008 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
7009 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007010
7011 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
7012
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007013 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
7014 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
7015 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
7016 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
7017 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
7018 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
7019 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
7020 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
7021 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
7022 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007023
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007024 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
7025 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
7026 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
7027 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
7028 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
7029 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
7030 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02007031 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
7032 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
7033 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
7034 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
7035 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
7036 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007037
7038 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
7039 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
7040 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
7041 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
7042 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
7043 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
7044 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
7045 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02007046 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007047 downsides of rare connection failures.
7048
7049 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
7050 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
7051 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
7052 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
7053 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
7054 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007055 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007056 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
7057 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
7058 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
7059 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
7060 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
7061
7062 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007063 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
7064 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
7065 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
7066 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007067
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007068 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
7069 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007070
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01007071 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007072
7073 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
7074 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
7075 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
7076
7077 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
7078
7079
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007080http-send-name-header [<header>]
7081 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007082 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7083 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007084 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007085 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
7086
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02007087 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
7088 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
7089 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
7090 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
7091 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
7092 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
7093 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
7094 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
7095 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
7096 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
7097 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
7098 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
7099 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
7100 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
7101 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
7102 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007103
7104 See also : "server"
7105
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007106id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007107 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
7108 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7109 no | yes | yes | yes
7110 Arguments : none
7111
7112 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
7113 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
7114 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007115
7116
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007117ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
7118 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
7119 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007120 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007121
7122 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7123 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7124 and running).
7125
7126 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7127 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7128 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007129 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007130 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7131
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007132 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7133 "unless" condition is met.
7134
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007135 Example:
7136 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7137 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7138 ignore-persist if url_static
7139
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007140 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7141
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007142load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7143 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7144 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7145 yes | no | yes | yes
7146
7147 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7148 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7149 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007150 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007151 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
7152 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7153 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7154 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7155
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007156 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007157 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007158 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007159
7160 Arguments:
7161 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7162 named "server-state-file".
7163
7164 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7165 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7166 name is used as a file name.
7167
7168 none don't load any stat for this backend
7169
7170 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007171 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7172 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7173 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007174 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007175 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007176
7177 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7178 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7179
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007180 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007181
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007182 global
7183 stats socket /tmp/socket
7184 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007185
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007186 defaults
7187 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007188
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007189 backend bk
7190 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7191 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007192
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007193
7194 Then one can run :
7195
7196 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7197
7198 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7199
7200 1
7201 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7202 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7203 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7204
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007205 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007206
7207 global
7208 stats socket /tmp/socket
7209 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7210
7211 defaults
7212 load-server-state-from-file local
7213
7214 backend bk
7215 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7216 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7217
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007218
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007219 Then one can run :
7220
7221 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7222
7223 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7224
7225 1
7226 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7227 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7228 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7229
7230 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7231 "show servers state"
7232
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007233
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007234log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007235log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007236 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007237no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007238 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7239 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7240 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007241
7242 Prefix :
7243 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7244 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7245 prefix does not allow arguments.
7246
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007247 Arguments :
7248 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7249 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7250 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7251 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7252 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7253 parameter.
7254
7255 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7256 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7257
7258 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7259 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7260 standard syslog port).
7261
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007262 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7263 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7264 standard syslog port).
7265
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007266 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7267 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7268 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007269 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007270
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007271 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7272 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7273 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7274 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7275 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7276 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7277 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7278 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7279 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7280 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7281 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7282 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
7283 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
7284 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7285 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7286 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007287 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7288 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007289
7290 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7291 and "fd@2", see above.
7292
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007293 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7294 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7295 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7296 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7297 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7298 having the logs instantly available.
7299
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007300 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7301 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007302
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007303 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7304 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7305 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7306 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7307 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7308 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7309 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7310 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7311 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7312 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007313 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007314
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007315 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7316 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7317 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7318 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7319 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7320
7321 <sample_size>
7322 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7323 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7324 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7325 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7326 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7327
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007328 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7329 one of the following :
7330
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007331 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7332 field is stripped. This is the default.
7333 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7334 rfc3164.
7335
7336 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007337 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7338
7339 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7340 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7341
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007342 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7343 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7344 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7345 designed to be used with a local log server.
7346
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007347 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7348 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7349 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7350 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7351 systemd logger consumes.
7352
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007353 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7354 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7355 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7356 used with a local log server.
7357
7358 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7359 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7360 designed to be used with a local log server.
7361
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007362 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7363 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7364 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7365 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7366
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007367 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7368
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007369 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7370 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7371 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7372
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007373 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7374 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7375 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7376 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007377
7378 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7379 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7380 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007381 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7382 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7383 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7384 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7385 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007386
7387 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7388
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007389 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7390 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7391 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007392
7393 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7394 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7395 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7396 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7397
7398 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7399 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007400
7401 Example :
7402 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007403 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7404 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7405 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007406 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
7407 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007408 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007409
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007410
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007411log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007412 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7413 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7414 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007415
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007416 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7417 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7418 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7419 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7420 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007421
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007422 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
7423 "option httplog" directives.
7424
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007425log-format-sd <string>
7426 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7427 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7428 yes | yes | yes | no
7429
7430 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7431 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7432 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7433 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7434 which covers the log format string in depth.
7435
7436 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7437 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7438
7439 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7440 log format to "rfc5424".
7441
7442 Example :
7443 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7444
7445
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007446log-tag <string>
7447 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7448 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7449 yes | yes | yes | yes
7450
7451 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7452 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
7453 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
7454 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7455 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7456 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7457 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7458 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7459 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007460
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007461max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7462 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7463 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7464 yes | no | yes | yes
7465
7466 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7467 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7468 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7469 servers.
7470
7471 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
7472 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
7473 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7474 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7475 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007476 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007477 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7478 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7479 picking a different server.
7480
7481 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7482 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7483 even if they have to be queued.
7484
7485 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7486 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7487
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007488max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7489 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7490 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7491 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007492
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007493maxconn <conns>
7494 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7495 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7496 yes | yes | yes | no
7497 Arguments :
7498 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7499 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7500 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7501 closes.
7502
7503 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
7504 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
7505 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7506 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007507 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7508 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7509 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7510 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007511
7512 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7513 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7514 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7515
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007516 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7517 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007518
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007519 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7520
7521
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02007522mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007523 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7524 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7525 yes | yes | yes | yes
7526 Arguments :
7527 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
7528 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
7529 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
7530 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
7531
7532 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
7533 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
7534 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
7535 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
7536 brings HAProxy most of its value.
7537
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007538 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
7539 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
7540 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007541
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007542 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007543 defaults http_instances
7544 mode http
7545
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007546
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007547monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007548 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007549 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7550 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007551 Arguments :
7552 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
7553 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007554 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007555 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
7556 backend and its backup.
7557
7558 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
7559 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
7560 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
7561 servers in a list of backends.
7562
7563 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
7564 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
7565 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
7566 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
7567 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
7568 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
7569 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02007570 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
7571 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007572
7573 Example:
7574 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007575 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007576 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7577 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7578 monitor-uri /site_alive
7579 monitor fail if site_dead
7580
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007581 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007582
7583
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007584monitor-uri <uri>
7585 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
7586 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7587 yes | yes | yes | no
7588 Arguments :
7589 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
7590 health status instead of forwarding the request.
7591
7592 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
7593 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
7594 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
7595 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
7596 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
7597 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
7598 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
7599 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
7600
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01007601 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007602 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
7603 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
7604 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
7605 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
7606 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
7607 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007608
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01007609 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
7610 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
7611 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
7612 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
7613
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007614 Example :
7615 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
7616 frontend www
7617 mode http
7618 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
7619
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007620 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007621
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007622
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007623option abortonclose
7624no option abortonclose
7625 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
7626 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7627 yes | no | yes | yes
7628 Arguments : none
7629
7630 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
7631 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
7632 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
7633 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007634 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007635 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
7636 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
7637 encountered while delivering the response.
7638
7639 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
7640 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
7641 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
7642 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
7643 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
7644 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007645 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007646 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007647 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007648 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
7649 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
7650 still not served and not pollute the servers.
7651
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007652 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
7653 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007654 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
7655 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
7656 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
7657 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
7658 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
7659 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007660 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007661
7662 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7663 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7664
7665 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
7666
7667
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007668option accept-invalid-http-request
7669no option accept-invalid-http-request
7670 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
7671 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7672 yes | yes | yes | no
7673 Arguments : none
7674
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007675 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007676 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007677 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007678 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7679 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7680 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7681 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7682 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007683 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
7684 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
7685 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
7686 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007687 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007688 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02007689 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
7690 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
7691 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007692
7693 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7694 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7695 been confirmed.
7696
7697 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7698 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007699 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
7700 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007701 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7702
7703 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7704 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7705
7706 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
7707 stats socket.
7708
7709
7710option accept-invalid-http-response
7711no option accept-invalid-http-response
7712 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
7713 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7714 yes | no | yes | yes
7715 Arguments : none
7716
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007717 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007718 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007719 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007720 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7721 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7722 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7723 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7724 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007725 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
7726 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
7727 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007728
7729 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7730 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7731 been confirmed.
7732
7733 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7734 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
7735 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
7736 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7737
7738 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7739 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7740
7741 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
7742 stats socket.
7743
7744
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007745option allbackups
7746no option allbackups
7747 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
7748 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7749 yes | no | yes | yes
7750 Arguments : none
7751
7752 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
7753 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
7754 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
7755 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
7756 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
7757 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
7758 order between the backup servers anymore.
7759
7760 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
7761 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
7762
7763 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7764 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7765
7766
7767option checkcache
7768no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08007769 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007770 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7771 yes | no | yes | yes
7772 Arguments : none
7773
7774 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
7775 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007776 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007777 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
7778 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007779 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007780
7781 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007782 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007783 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007784 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
7785 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007786 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007787 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01007788 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
7789 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007790 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01007791 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
7792 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007793 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007794 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
7795 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
7796 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
7797 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
7798 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
7799 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
7800 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
7801 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
7802 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
7803
7804 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007805 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
7806 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
7807 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
7808 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007809
7810 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
7811 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007812 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007813 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007814
7815 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7816 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7817
7818
7819option clitcpka
7820no option clitcpka
7821 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
7822 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7823 yes | yes | yes | no
7824 Arguments : none
7825
7826 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7827 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007828 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007829 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7830
7831 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7832 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7833 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7834 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7835
7836 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7837 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7838 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7839 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7840 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7841
7842 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7843
7844 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7845 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7846 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
7847
7848 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7849 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7850
7851 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
7852
7853
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007854option contstats
7855 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
7856 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7857 yes | yes | yes | no
7858 Arguments : none
7859
7860 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
7861 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
7862 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
7863 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01007864 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
7865 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
7866 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
7867 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
7868 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007869
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02007870option disable-h2-upgrade
7871no option disable-h2-upgrade
7872 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
7873 connection.
7874 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7875 yes | yes | yes | no
7876 Arguments : none
7877
7878 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
7879 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
7880 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
7881 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
7882 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be used to
7883 disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only supported
7884 for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to force the
7885 HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind line.
7886
7887 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7888 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007889
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007890option dontlog-normal
7891no option dontlog-normal
7892 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
7893 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7894 yes | yes | yes | no
7895 Arguments : none
7896
7897 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
7898 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
7899 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
7900 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
7901 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
7902 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
7903 logged.
7904
7905 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
7906 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
7907 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
7908
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007909 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007910 logging.
7911
7912
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007913option dontlognull
7914no option dontlognull
7915 Enable or disable logging of null connections
7916 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7917 yes | yes | yes | no
7918 Arguments : none
7919
7920 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
7921 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
7922 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
7923 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
7924 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
7925 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007926 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
7927 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
7928 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007929
7930 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007931 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007932 would not be logged.
7933
7934 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7935 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7936
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007937 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007938 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007939
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007940
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007941option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007942 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
7943 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7944 yes | yes | yes | yes
7945 Arguments :
7946 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7947 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007948 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007949 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007950
7951 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
7952 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
7953 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
7954 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
7955 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
7956 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
7957 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007958 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
7959 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7960 possible that the client has already brought one.
7961
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007962 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007963 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007964 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007965 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007966 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007967 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007968
7969 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7970 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7971 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7972 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7973 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7974 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7975 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7976
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007977 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
7978 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
7979 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
7980 are under the control of the end-user.
7981
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007982 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007983 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7984 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007985 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
7986 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
7987 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007988
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007989 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007990 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
7991 frontend www
7992 mode http
7993 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
7994
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007995 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
7996 backend www
7997 mode http
7998 option forwardfor header X-Client
7999
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008000 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008001 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008002
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008003
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02008004option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8005no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8006 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
8007 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8008 yes | yes | yes | no
8009 Arguments : none
8010
8011 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8012 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8013 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8014 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8015 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8016 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8017 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8018
8019 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
8020 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
8021 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
8022 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8023 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
8024 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8025 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8026 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
8027 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8028 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8029
8030 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
8031
8032 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8033 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8034
8035 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
8036 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8037
8038
8039option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8040no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8041 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
8042 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8043 yes | no | yes | yes
8044 Arguments : none
8045
8046 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8047 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8048 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8049 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8050 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8051 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8052 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8053
8054 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
8055 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
8056 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
8057 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8058 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
8059 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8060 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8061 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
8062 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8063 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8064
8065 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
8066
8067 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8068 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8069
8070 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
8071 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8072
8073
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008074option http-buffer-request
8075no option http-buffer-request
8076 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
8077 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8078 yes | yes | yes | yes
8079 Arguments : none
8080
8081 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
8082 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
8083 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
8084 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
8085 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
8086 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01008087 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
8088 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
8089 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
8090 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008091
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01008092 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008093
8094
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008095option http-ignore-probes
8096no option http-ignore-probes
8097 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
8098 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8099 yes | yes | yes | no
8100 Arguments : none
8101
8102 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
8103 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
8104 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
8105 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
8106 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
8107 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
8108 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
8109 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
8110 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008111 was received over a connection before it was closed;
8112 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008113 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
8114
8115 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
8116 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
8117 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
8118 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
8119 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8120 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8121 are often the only way to detect them.
8122
8123 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8124 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8125
8126 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8127
8128
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008129option http-keep-alive
8130no option http-keep-alive
8131 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
8132 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8133 yes | yes | yes | yes
8134 Arguments : none
8135
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008136 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8137 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008138 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8139 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008140 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
8141 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
8142 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008143
8144 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8145 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008146 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8147 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8148 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8149 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8150 situations where this option may be useful :
8151
8152 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008153 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008154
8155 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8156 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8157
8158 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8159 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8160 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8161 request.
8162
8163 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8164 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008165 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8166 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8167 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008168
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008169 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8170 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8171 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8172 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8173 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8174 not set.
8175
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008176 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8177 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8178 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008179
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008180 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008181 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008182 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008183
8184
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008185option http-no-delay
8186no option http-no-delay
8187 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8188 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8189 yes | yes | yes | yes
8190 Arguments : none
8191
8192 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8193 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8194 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8195 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8196 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8197 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8198 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
8199 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
8200 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8201 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8202 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8203 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8204 affected.
8205
8206 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8207 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8208 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8209 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8210 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8211 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8212 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8213 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8214 latency environments.
8215
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008216 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8217
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008218
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008219option http-pretend-keepalive
8220no option http-pretend-keepalive
8221 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
8222 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008223 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008224 Arguments : none
8225
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008226 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008227 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8228 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8229 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
8230 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
8231 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8232 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8233 consider the response complete.
8234
8235 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
8236 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
8237 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
8238 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008239 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008240 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8241
8242 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8243 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8244 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8245 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
8246 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
8247 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
8248 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8249
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008250 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8251 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8252 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8253 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8254 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8255 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008256
8257 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8258 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8259
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008260 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008261 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008262
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008263
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008264option http-server-close
8265no option http-server-close
8266 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8267 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8268 yes | yes | yes | yes
8269 Arguments : none
8270
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008271 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8272 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8273 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8274 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008275 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8276 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8277 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8278 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8279 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8280 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8281 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8282 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8283 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8284 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8285 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008286
8287 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8288 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8289 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8290 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008291 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8292 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008293
8294 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8295 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008296 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8297 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8298 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008299
8300 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8301 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8302
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008303 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
8304 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008305
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008306option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008307no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008308 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8309 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8310 yes | yes | yes | no
8311 Arguments : none
8312
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008313 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008314 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8315 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8316 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8317 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8318 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
8319 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
8320
8321 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
8322 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008323 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8324 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8325 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008326
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008327 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8328 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8329 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8330 front of an existing proxy.
8331
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008332 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8333
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008334 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008335
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008336option httpchk
8337option httpchk <uri>
8338option httpchk <method> <uri>
8339option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008340 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008341 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8342 yes | no | yes | yes
8343 Arguments :
8344 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8345 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8346 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8347 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8348 ones.
8349
8350 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8351 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8352 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8353
8354 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8355 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8356 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008357 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008358
8359 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8360 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8361 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8362 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8363 the lack of any response.
8364
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008365 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8366 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8367 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8368 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8369
8370 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8371 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8372 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008373
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008374 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8375 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008376 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008377 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008378 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008379
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008380 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8381 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8382 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8383 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8384
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008385 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008386 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8387 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8388 backend https_relay
8389 mode tcp
8390 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8391 http-check send hdr Host www
8392 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008393
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008394 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8395 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8396 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008397
8398
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008399option httpclose
8400no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008401 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008402 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8403 yes | yes | yes | yes
8404 Arguments : none
8405
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008406 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8407 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8408 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8409 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008410 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008411
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008412 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8413 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008414 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008415 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8416 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008417
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008418 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8419 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8420 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008421
8422 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8423 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008424 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8425 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8426 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008427
8428 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8429 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8430
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008431 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008432
8433
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008434option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008435 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8436 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008437 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008438 Arguments :
8439 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8440 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8441 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008442 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008443 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008444
8445 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8446 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8447 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8448 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8449 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8450 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8451 ports.
8452
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008453 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8454 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008455
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008456 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8457
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008458 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008459
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008460
8461option http_proxy
8462no option http_proxy
8463 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
8464 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8465 yes | yes | yes | yes
8466 Arguments : none
8467
8468 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
8469 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
8470 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
8471 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
8472 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
8473
8474 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
8475 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008476 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
8477 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008478
8479 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8480 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8481
8482 Example :
8483 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
8484 backend direct_forward
8485 option httpclose
8486 option http_proxy
8487
8488 See also : "option httpclose"
8489
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008490
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008491option independent-streams
8492no option independent-streams
8493 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8495 yes | yes | yes | yes
8496 Arguments : none
8497
8498 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
8499 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
8500 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
8501 receive data or not.
8502
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008503 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008504 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
8505 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
8506 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
8507 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
8508 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
8509 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
8510 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
8511 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
8512 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
8513 socket buffers.
8514
8515 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
8516 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
8517 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
8518 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
8519 slow lines, so use it with caution.
8520
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008521 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008522
8523
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02008524option ldap-check
8525 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
8526 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8527 yes | no | yes | yes
8528 Arguments : none
8529
8530 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
8531 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
8532 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
8533 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
8534
8535 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
8536 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
8537
8538 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
8539 configure it.
8540
8541 Example :
8542 option ldap-check
8543
8544 See also : "option httpchk"
8545
8546
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008547option external-check
8548 Use external processes for server health checks
8549 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8550 yes | no | yes | yes
8551
8552 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
8553 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
8554 command".
8555
8556 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
8557
8558 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
8559
8560
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008561option log-health-checks
8562no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008563 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008564 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8565 yes | no | yes | yes
8566 Arguments : none
8567
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008568 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
8569 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
8570 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008571
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008572 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
8573 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
8574 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
8575 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
8576 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
8577
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008578 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008579 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008580
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008581 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
8582 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
8583 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008584
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008585
8586option log-separate-errors
8587no option log-separate-errors
8588 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
8589 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8590 yes | yes | yes | no
8591 Arguments : none
8592
8593 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
8594 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
8595 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
8596 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
8597 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
8598 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
8599 provides very important information.
8600
8601 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
8602 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
8603 error logs.
8604
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008605 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008606 logging.
8607
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008608
8609option logasap
8610no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008611 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008612 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8613 yes | yes | yes | no
8614 Arguments : none
8615
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008616 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
8617 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
8618 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
8619 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
8620
8621 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
8622 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
8623 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
8624 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
8625 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008626 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008627 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
8628 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
8629 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
8630 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008631 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008632
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008633 Examples :
8634 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
8635 mode http
8636 option httplog
8637 option logasap
8638 log 192.168.2.200 local3
8639
8640 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8641 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8642 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
8643 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
8644
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008645 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008646 logging.
8647
8648
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008649option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008650 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008651 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8652 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008653 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008654 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
8655 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008656 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
8657 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008658
8659 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
8660 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008661 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008662 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
8663 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
8664 in the MySQL table, like this :
8665
8666 USE mysql;
8667 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
8668 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
8669
8670 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008671 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008672 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
8673 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
8674 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
8675 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
8676 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
8677 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
8678 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
8679
8680 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
8681 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008682
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02008683 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008684
8685 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
8686 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
8687 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8688 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008689 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
8690 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008691
8692 See also: "option httpchk"
8693
8694
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008695option nolinger
8696no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008697 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008698 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8699 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008700 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008701
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008702 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008703 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
8704 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
8705 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
8706 connections.
8707
8708 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
8709 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008710 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
8711 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
8712 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
8713 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
8714 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
8715 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
8716 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
8717 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
8718 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
8719 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
8720 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
8721 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
8722 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008723
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008724 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
8725 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
8726 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
8727 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
8728 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008729
8730 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
8731 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008732 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05008733 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008734 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008735
8736 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8737 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8738
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008739 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
8740 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008741
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008742option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
8743 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
8744 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8745 yes | yes | yes | yes
8746 Arguments :
8747 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8748 matching <network>
8749 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
8750 header name.
8751
8752 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
8753 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
8754 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
8755 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
8756 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
8757 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
8758 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
8759 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
8760 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8761 possible that the client has already brought one.
8762
8763 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
8764 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
8765 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
8766 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
8767 header and requires different one.
8768
8769 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8770 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8771 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8772 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8773 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8774 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
8775 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
8776
8777 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
8778 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8779 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
8780 both are defined.
8781
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008782 Examples :
8783 # Original Destination address
8784 frontend www
8785 mode http
8786 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
8787
8788 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
8789 backend www
8790 mode http
8791 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
8792
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008793 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008794
8795
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008796option persist
8797no option persist
8798 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
8799 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8800 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008801 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008802
8803 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
8804 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
8805 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
8806 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
8807 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
8808 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
8809 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
8810 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
8811 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
8812 redirected to another valid server.
8813
8814 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8815 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8816
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01008817 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008818
8819
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01008820option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
8821 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
8822 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8823 yes | no | yes | yes
8824 Arguments :
8825 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
8826 PostgreSQL server.
8827
8828 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
8829 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
8830 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
8831 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
8832
8833 See also: "option httpchk"
8834
8835
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008836option prefer-last-server
8837no option prefer-last-server
8838 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
8839 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8840 yes | no | yes | yes
8841 Arguments : none
8842
8843 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
8844 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
8845 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
8846 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
8847 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
8848 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
8849 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
8850 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
8851 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008852 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
8853 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02008854 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
8855 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
8856 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008857 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
8858 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
8859 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008860
8861 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8862 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8863
8864 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
8865
8866
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008867option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008868option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008869no option redispatch
8870 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
8871 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8872 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008873 Arguments :
8874 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
8875 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
8876 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008877 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008878 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008879 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008880 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
8881 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
8882 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
8883
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008884
8885 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
8886 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
8887 be able to access the service anymore.
8888
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01008889 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
8890 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008891
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02008892 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
8893 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
8894 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
8895 following order:
8896
8897 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
8898
8899 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
8900 list, or
8901
8902 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
8903
8904 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
8905 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
8906
8907 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
8908 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
8909 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
8910 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
8911
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008912 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008913 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
8914 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008915
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008916 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8917 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8918
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008919 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008920
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008921
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008922option redis-check
8923 Use redis health checks for server testing
8924 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8925 yes | no | yes | yes
8926 Arguments : none
8927
8928 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
8929 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8930 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
8931 find the "+PONG" response message.
8932
8933 Example :
8934 option redis-check
8935
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03008936 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008937
8938
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008939option smtpchk
8940option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
8941 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
8942 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8943 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008944 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008945 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02008946 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008947 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
8948
8949 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
8950 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
8951 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
8952
8953 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
8954 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
8955 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
8956 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
8957 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
8958 dead server.
8959
8960 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
8961 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008962 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008963 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
8964
8965 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
8966 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
8967 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8968 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008969 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008970
8971 Example :
8972 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
8973
8974 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
8975
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008976
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02008977option socket-stats
8978no option socket-stats
8979
8980 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
8981 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8982 yes | yes | yes | no
8983
8984 Arguments : none
8985
8986
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008987option splice-auto
8988no option splice-auto
8989 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
8990 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8991 yes | yes | yes | yes
8992 Arguments : none
8993
8994 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
8995 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008996 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008997 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008998 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008999 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
9000 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
9001 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
9002 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9003
9004 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
9005 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
9006 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
9007 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
9008 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
9009 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
9010 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
9011 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
9012 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
9013 keyword.
9014
9015 Example :
9016 option splice-auto
9017
9018 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9019 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9020
9021 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
9022 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9023
9024
9025option splice-request
9026no option splice-request
9027 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
9028 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9029 yes | yes | yes | yes
9030 Arguments : none
9031
9032 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009033 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009034 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9035 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9036 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9037 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9038
9039 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9040
9041 Example :
9042 option splice-request
9043
9044 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9045 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9046
9047 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
9048 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9049
9050
9051option splice-response
9052no option splice-response
9053 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
9054 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9055 yes | yes | yes | yes
9056 Arguments : none
9057
9058 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009059 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009060 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9061 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9062 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9063 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9064
9065 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9066
9067 Example :
9068 option splice-response
9069
9070 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9071 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9072
9073 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
9074 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9075
9076
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009077option spop-check
9078 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
9079 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9080 no | no | no | yes
9081 Arguments : none
9082
9083 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
9084 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9085 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
9086 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
9087
9088 Example :
9089 option spop-check
9090
9091 See also : "option httpchk"
9092
9093
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009094option srvtcpka
9095no option srvtcpka
9096 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
9097 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9098 yes | no | yes | yes
9099 Arguments : none
9100
9101 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9102 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009103 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009104 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9105
9106 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9107 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9108 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9109 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9110
9111 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9112 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9113 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9114 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9115 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9116
9117 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9118
9119 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9120 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9121 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
9122
9123 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9124 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9125
9126 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
9127
9128
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009129option ssl-hello-chk
9130 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
9131 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9132 yes | no | yes | yes
9133 Arguments : none
9134
9135 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9136 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9137 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9138 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9139 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9140 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9141 hello message.
9142
9143 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9144 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9145 messages, which is appreciable.
9146
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009147 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
9148 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9149 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009150
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009151 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9152
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009153
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009154option tcp-check
9155 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9156 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9157 yes | no | yes | yes
9158
9159 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9160 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9161
9162 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9163 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9164 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9165
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009166 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009167 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9168 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9169 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9170 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9171 only.
9172
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009173 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009174 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
9175 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9176 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9177 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9178
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009179 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009180 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9181 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009182 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009183 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9184 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9185 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9186 the respective protocols.
9187 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009188 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009189
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009190 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009191
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009192 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9193 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9194 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9195 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009196
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009197 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9198 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9199 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009200
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009201
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009202 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009203 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009204 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009205 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009206
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009207 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009208 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009209 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009210
9211 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9212 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009213 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009214 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009215 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009216 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009217 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009218 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009219 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9220 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009221 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009222 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9223 tcp-check expect string +OK
9224
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009225 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009226 (send many headers before analyzing)
9227 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009228 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009229 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9230 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9231 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9232 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009233 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009234
9235
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009236 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009237
9238
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009239option tcp-smart-accept
9240no option tcp-smart-accept
9241 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9242 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9243 yes | yes | yes | no
9244 Arguments : none
9245
9246 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9247 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9248 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9249 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9250 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9251 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9252
9253 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9254 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9255 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9256 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9257
9258 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9259 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9260 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009261 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009262
9263 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9264 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9265 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9266
9267 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9268 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9269 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9270
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009271 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9272
9273
9274option tcp-smart-connect
9275no option tcp-smart-connect
9276 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9277 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9278 yes | no | yes | yes
9279 Arguments : none
9280
9281 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9282 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9283 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9284 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9285 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9286
9287 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9288 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9289 complex.
9290
9291 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9292 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9293 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9294
9295 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9296 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9297
9298 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9299
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009300
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009301option tcpka
9302 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9303 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9304 yes | yes | yes | yes
9305 Arguments : none
9306
9307 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9308 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009309 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009310 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9311
9312 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9313 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9314 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9315 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9316
9317 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9318 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9319 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9320 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9321 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9322
9323 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9324
9325 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9326 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9327 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9328 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9329 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9330 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9331 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9332 backends.
9333
9334 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9335
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009336
9337option tcplog
9338 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9339 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009340 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009341 Arguments : none
9342
9343 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9344 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9345 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9346 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9347 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9348 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9349 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9350 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9351
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009352 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9353
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009354 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009355
9356
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009357option transparent
9358no option transparent
9359 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9360 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009361 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009362 Arguments : none
9363
9364 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9365 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9366 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9367 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9368 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9369 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9370 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9371 appropriate server.
9372
9373 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9374 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9375
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009376 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009377 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009378
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009379
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009380external-check command <command>
9381 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9382 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9383 yes | no | yes | yes
9384
9385 Arguments :
9386 <command> is the external command to run
9387
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009388 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9389
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009390 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009391
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009392 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9393 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9394 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9395 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9396 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9397 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009398
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009399 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9400
9401 Environment variables :
9402 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9403 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9404
9405 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9406
9407 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9408
9409 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9410 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9411 for a UNIX socket).
9412
9413 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9414
9415 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9416
9417 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9418
9419 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9420
9421 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9422
9423 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9424 socket).
9425
9426 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9427 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9428
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009429 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9430
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009431 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9432 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9433 failed.
9434
9435 Example :
9436 external-check command /bin/true
9437
9438 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9439
9440
9441external-check path <path>
9442 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9443 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9444 yes | no | yes | yes
9445
9446 Arguments :
9447 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9448
9449 The default path is "".
9450
9451 Example :
9452 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9453
9454 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9455 "external-check command"
9456
9457
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009458persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009459persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009460 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9461 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9462 yes | no | yes | yes
9463 Arguments :
9464 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009465 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9466 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009467
9468 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
9469 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009470 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009471 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
9472 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
9473 forwarded to this server.
9474
9475 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
9476 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
9477 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009478 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009479 a single "listen" section.
9480
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009481 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
9482 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
9483 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
9484
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009485 Example :
9486 listen tse-farm
9487 bind :3389
9488 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9489 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9490 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9491 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9492 persist rdp-cookie
9493 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009494 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009495 balance rdp-cookie
9496 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9497 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
9498
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009499 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
9500 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009501
9502
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009503rate-limit sessions <rate>
9504 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
9505 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9506 yes | yes | yes | no
9507 Arguments :
9508 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
9509 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
9510
9511 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
9512 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
9513 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
9514 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
9515 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
9516 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
9517
9518 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
9519 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
9520 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
9521 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
9522
9523 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
9524 listen smtp
9525 mode tcp
9526 bind :25
9527 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02009528 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009529
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02009530 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
9531 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
9532 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009533
9534 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
9535
9536
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009537redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9538redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9539redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009540 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
9541 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9542 no | yes | yes | yes
9543
9544 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01009545 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009546
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009547 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009548 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009549 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
9550 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
9551 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009552
9553 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
9554 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
9555 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
9556 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
9557 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009558 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
9559 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
9560 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
9561 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009562
9563 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
9564 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
9565 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
9566 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
9567 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
9568 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009569 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009570 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009571 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
9572 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
9573 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009574
9575 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009576 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
9577 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
9578 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02009579 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009580 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
9581 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
9582 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
9583 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009584
9585 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009586 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009587
9588 - "drop-query"
9589 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
9590 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
9591 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
9592 with a location-type redirect.
9593
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009594 - "append-slash"
9595 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
9596 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
9597 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
9598 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
9599
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009600 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
9601 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
9602 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
9603 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
9604 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
9605 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
9606 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
9607
9608 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
9609 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
9610 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
9611 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
9612 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
9613 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
9614 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009615
9616 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
9617 acl clear dst_port 80
9618 acl secure dst_port 8080
9619 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009620 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009621 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009622 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
9623
9624 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009625 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
9626 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
9627 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009628 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009629
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009630 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
9631 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
9632 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
9633
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009634 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01009635 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009636
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009637 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02009638 http-request redirect code 301 location \
9639 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
9640 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009641
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009642 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009643
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01009644
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009645retries <value>
9646 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
9647 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9648 yes | no | yes | yes
9649 Arguments :
9650 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
9651 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
9652 default value is 3.
9653
9654 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
9655 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
9656 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
9657
9658 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009659 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
9660 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009661
9662 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
9663 server even if a cookie references a different server.
9664
9665 See also : "option redispatch"
9666
9667
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009668retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +02009669 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
9670 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
9671 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009672 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9673 yes | no | yes | yes
9674 Arguments :
9675 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
9676 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
9677 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
9678 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
9679
9680 none never retry
9681
9682 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
9683 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
9684
9685 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
9686 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
9687 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
9688 request timeout on the server side, poor network
9689 condition, or a server crash or restart while
9690 processing the request.
9691
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02009692 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
9693 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
9694 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
9695 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
9696 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
9697 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
9698 overflow attack for example).
9699
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009700 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
9701 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
9702 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
9703 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
9704 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
9705 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
9706 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
9707 amplify denial of service attacks.
9708
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02009709 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
9710 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
9711 considered to be safe to retry.
9712
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +01009713 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
9714 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
9715 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
9716 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
9717 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009718
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02009719 all-retryable-errors
9720 retry request for any error that are considered
9721 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
9722 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
9723 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
9724
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009725 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
9726 not cumulative.
9727
9728 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
9729 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
9730 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
9731 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
9732
9733 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
9734 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
9735 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
9736 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
9737 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
9738 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
9739 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
9740 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
9741 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
9742 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
9743 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
9744 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
9745
9746 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
9747 should not use this directive.
9748
9749 The default is "conn-failure".
9750
9751 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
9752
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009753server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009754 Declare a server in a backend
9755 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9756 no | no | yes | yes
9757 Arguments :
9758 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009759 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009760 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009761
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009762 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
9763 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
9764 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
9765 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02009766 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
9767 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
9768 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
9769 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
9770 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009771 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
9772 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
9773 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
9774 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
9775 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9776 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9777 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009778 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02009779 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
9780 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
9781 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
9782 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
9783 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
9784 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009785 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9786 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01009787 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
9788 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009789
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009790 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009791 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
9792 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
9793 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
9794 adding this value to the client's port.
9795
9796 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
9797 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009798 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009799
9800 Examples :
9801 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
9802 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009803 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009804 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
9805 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
9806 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009807
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02009808 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
9809 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
9810 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
9811 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
9812 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
9813
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009814 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
9815 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009816
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +01009817server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009818 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +01009819 this backend.
9820 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9821 no | no | yes | yes
9822
9823 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
9824 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
9825 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
9826 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
9827 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009828
9829 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
9830 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
9831
9832 global
9833 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
9834
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01009835 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009836 load-server-state-from-file
9837
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +01009838 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009839 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009840
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02009841server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
9842 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
9843 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
9844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9845 no | no | yes | yes
9846
9847 Arguments:
9848 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
9849
9850 <num | range>
9851 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
9852 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
9853 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
9854 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
9855
9856 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
9857
9858 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
9859
9860 <params*>
9861 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
9862 keyword.
9863
9864 Examples:
9865 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
9866 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
9867 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
9868
9869 # or
9870 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
9871
9872 # would be equivalent to:
9873 server srv1 google.com:80 check
9874 server srv2 google.com:80 check
9875 server srv3 google.com:80 check
9876
9877
9878
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009879source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009880source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009881source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009882 Set the source address for outgoing connections
9883 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9884 yes | no | yes | yes
9885 Arguments :
9886 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
9887 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009888
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009889 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009890 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
9891 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
9892 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
9893 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
9894 supported prefixes are :
9895 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9896 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9897 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009898 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02009899 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9900 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009901
9902 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
9903 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009904 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
9905 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
9906 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009907
9908 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
9909 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
9910 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
9911 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
9912 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
9913 <addr>.
9914
9915 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
9916 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
9917 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
9918 port.
9919
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009920 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
9921 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
9922 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
9923 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01009924 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009925 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
9926 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
9927 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
9928 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
9929 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
9930 HTTP header.
9931
9932 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
9933 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009934 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009935 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
9936 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
9937 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
9938 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
9939 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
9940 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
9941 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
9942
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009943 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
9944 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
9945 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
9946 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
9947 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
9948 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
9949
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009950 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
9951 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
9952 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
9953 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
9954
9955 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
9956 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
9957 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
9958 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
9959 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
9960 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
9961
9962 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
9963 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
9964 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
9965 there are two methods :
9966
9967 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
9968 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
9969 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
9970 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
9971 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
9972 of the client ranges may be used.
9973
9974 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
9975 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
9976 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
9977 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
9978 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
9979 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
9980 same session.
9981
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009982 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
9983 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
9984 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009985 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009986
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02009987 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
9988
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009989 Examples :
9990 backend private
9991 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
9992 source 192.168.1.200
9993
9994 backend transparent_ssl1
9995 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
9996 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9997
9998 backend transparent_ssl2
9999 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
10000 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
10001 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
10002
10003 backend transparent_ssl3
10004 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
10005 # is more conntrack-friendly.
10006 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10007
10008 backend transparent_smtp
10009 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
10010 # with Tproxy version 4.
10011 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
10012
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010013 backend transparent_http
10014 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
10015 # proxy.
10016 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
10017
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010018 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010019 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
10020
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010021
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010022srvtcpka-cnt <count>
10023 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
10024 the connection on the server side.
10025 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10026 yes | no | yes | yes
10027 Arguments :
10028 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
10029
10030 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
10031 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010032 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10033 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010034
10035 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10036
10037
10038srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
10039 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
10040 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
10041 server side.
10042 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10043 yes | no | yes | yes
10044 Arguments :
10045 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
10046 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
10047 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
10048 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
10049
10050 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
10051 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010052 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10053 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010054
10055 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10056
10057
10058srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
10059 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
10060 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10061 yes | no | yes | yes
10062 Arguments :
10063 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
10064 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
10065 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
10066 document.
10067
10068 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
10069 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010070 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10071 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010072
10073 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
10074
10075
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010076stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
10077 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
10078 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010079 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010080
10081 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
10082 matched.
10083
10084 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
10085 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
10086
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010087 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10088 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010089 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010090
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010010091 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
10092 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
10093 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
10094 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010095
10096 Example :
10097 # statistics admin level only for localhost
10098 backend stats_localhost
10099 stats enable
10100 stats admin if LOCALHOST
10101
10102 Example :
10103 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
10104 backend stats_auth
10105 stats enable
10106 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
10107 stats admin if TRUE
10108
10109 Example :
10110 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
10111 userlist stats-auth
10112 group admin users admin
10113 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
10114 group readonly users haproxy
10115 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
10116
10117 backend stats_auth
10118 stats enable
10119 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
10120 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
10121 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
10122 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
10123
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010124 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
10125 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
10126 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010127
10128
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010129stats auth <user>:<passwd>
10130 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
10131 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010132 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010133 Arguments :
10134 <user> is a user name to grant access to
10135
10136 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10137
10138 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10139 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10140 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10141 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10142 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10143 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10144
10145 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10146 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10147 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010148 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010149
10150 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10151 report using "stats scope".
10152
10153 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10154 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10155 unobvious parameters.
10156
10157 Example :
10158 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10159 backend public_www
10160 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10161 stats enable
10162 stats hide-version
10163 stats scope .
10164 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010165 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010166 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10167 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10168
10169 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10170 backend private_monitoring
10171 stats enable
10172 stats uri /admin?stats
10173 stats refresh 5s
10174
10175 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10176
10177
10178stats enable
10179 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10180 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010181 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010182 Arguments : none
10183
10184 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10185 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10186 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10187 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10188 - stats auth : no authentication
10189 - stats scope : no restriction
10190
10191 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10192 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10193 unobvious parameters.
10194
10195 Example :
10196 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10197 backend public_www
10198 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10199 stats enable
10200 stats hide-version
10201 stats scope .
10202 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010203 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010204 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10205 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10206
10207 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10208 backend private_monitoring
10209 stats enable
10210 stats uri /admin?stats
10211 stats refresh 5s
10212
10213 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10214
10215
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010216stats hide-version
10217 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010218 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010219 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010220 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010221
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010222 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10223 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10224 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10225 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10226 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10227 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010228
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010229 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10230 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10231 unobvious parameters.
10232
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010233 Example :
10234 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10235 backend public_www
10236 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010237 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010238 stats hide-version
10239 stats scope .
10240 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010241 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010242 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10243 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010244
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010245 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10246 backend private_monitoring
10247 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010248 stats uri /admin?stats
10249 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010250
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010251 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010252
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010253
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010254stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10255 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10256 Access control for statistics
10257
10258 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10259 no | no | yes | yes
10260
10261 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10262 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10263 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10264 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10265 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10266 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10267
10268 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10269 instance.
10270
10271 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10272 about ACL usage.
10273
10274
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010275stats realm <realm>
10276 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10277 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010278 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010279 Arguments :
10280 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10281 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10282 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10283
10284 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10285 using a backslash ('\').
10286
10287 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10288 only related to authentication.
10289
10290 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10291 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10292 unobvious parameters.
10293
10294 Example :
10295 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10296 backend public_www
10297 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10298 stats enable
10299 stats hide-version
10300 stats scope .
10301 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010302 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010303 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10304 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10305
10306 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10307 backend private_monitoring
10308 stats enable
10309 stats uri /admin?stats
10310 stats refresh 5s
10311
10312 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10313
10314
10315stats refresh <delay>
10316 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10317 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010318 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010319 Arguments :
10320 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10321 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10322 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10323 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10324 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10325 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10326
10327 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10328 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10329 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010330 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010331
10332 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10333 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10334 unobvious parameters.
10335
10336 Example :
10337 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10338 backend public_www
10339 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10340 stats enable
10341 stats hide-version
10342 stats scope .
10343 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010344 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010345 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10346 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10347
10348 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10349 backend private_monitoring
10350 stats enable
10351 stats uri /admin?stats
10352 stats refresh 5s
10353
10354 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10355
10356
10357stats scope { <name> | "." }
10358 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10359 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010360 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010361 Arguments :
10362 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10363 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10364 section in which the statement appears.
10365
10366 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10367 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10368 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10369 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10370 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10371 exists.
10372
10373 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10374 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10375 unobvious parameters.
10376
10377 Example :
10378 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10379 backend public_www
10380 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10381 stats enable
10382 stats hide-version
10383 stats scope .
10384 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010385 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010386 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10387 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10388
10389 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10390 backend private_monitoring
10391 stats enable
10392 stats uri /admin?stats
10393 stats refresh 5s
10394
10395 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10396
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010397
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010398stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010399 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10400 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010401 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010402
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010403 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010404 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10405
10406 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10407 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10408
10409 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10410 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010411 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010412
10413 Example :
10414 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10415 backend private_monitoring
10416 stats enable
10417 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10418 stats uri /admin?stats
10419 stats refresh 5s
10420
10421 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10422 global section.
10423
10424
10425stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010426 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10427 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10428 yes | yes | yes | yes
10429 Arguments : none
10430
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010431 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010432 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10433 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10434 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10435 - IP (socket, server)
10436 - cookie (backend, server)
10437
10438 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10439 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010440 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010441
10442 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10443
10444
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010445stats show-modules
10446 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10447 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10448 yes | yes | yes | yes
10449 Arguments : none
10450
10451 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10452 values as a tooltip.
10453
10454 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10455 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10456 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
10457
10458 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10459
10460
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010461stats show-node [ <name> ]
10462 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
10463 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010464 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010465 Arguments:
10466 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
10467 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
10468
10469 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10470 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010471 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010472
10473 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10474 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10475 unobvious parameters.
10476
10477 Example:
10478 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10479 backend private_monitoring
10480 stats enable
10481 stats show-node Europe-1
10482 stats uri /admin?stats
10483 stats refresh 5s
10484
10485 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
10486 section.
10487
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010488
10489stats uri <prefix>
10490 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
10491 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010492 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010493 Arguments :
10494 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
10495 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
10496 query string.
10497
10498 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
10499 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
10500 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
10501 possible to reach it in the application.
10502
10503 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010504 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010505 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
10506 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
10507 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
10508 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
10509
10510 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
10511 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
10512 an address or a port to statistics only.
10513
10514 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10515 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10516 unobvious parameters.
10517
10518 Example :
10519 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10520 backend public_www
10521 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10522 stats enable
10523 stats hide-version
10524 stats scope .
10525 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010526 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010527 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10528 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10529
10530 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10531 backend private_monitoring
10532 stats enable
10533 stats uri /admin?stats
10534 stats refresh 5s
10535
10536 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
10537
10538
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010539stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
10540 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010541 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010542 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010543
10544 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010545 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010546 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010547 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010548 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
10549
10550 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10551 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10552 the "stick-table" statement.
10553
10554 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
10555 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
10556 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
10557 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
10558 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
10559
10560 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10561 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
10562 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
10563 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
10564 transformation rules.
10565
10566 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10567 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10568 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10569 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10570 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10571 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10572 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10573
10574 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
10575 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
10576 ACL based conditions.
10577
10578 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
10579 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
10580 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
10581 matches can be used as fallbacks.
10582
10583 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
10584 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
10585 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
10586 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
10587
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010588 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10589 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010590 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010591
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010592 Example :
10593 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10594 # last 30 minutes
10595 backend pop
10596 mode tcp
10597 balance roundrobin
10598 stick store-request src
10599 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10600 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10601 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10602
10603 backend smtp
10604 mode tcp
10605 balance roundrobin
10606 stick match src table pop
10607 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10608 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10609
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010610 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010611 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010612
10613
10614stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10615 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
10616 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10617 no | no | yes | yes
10618
10619 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
10620 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
10621 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
10622 for writing more maintainable configurations.
10623
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010624 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10625 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010626 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010627
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010628 Examples :
10629 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010010630 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010631
10632 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
10633 stick match src table pop if !localhost
10634 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
10635
10636
10637 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
10638 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
10639 backend http
10640 mode http
10641 balance roundrobin
10642 stick on src table https
10643 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
10644 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
10645 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
10646
10647 backend https
10648 mode tcp
10649 balance roundrobin
10650 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10651 stick on src
10652 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10653 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10654
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010655 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010656
10657
10658stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10659 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
10660 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10661 no | no | yes | yes
10662
10663 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010664 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010665 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010666 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010667 server is selected.
10668
10669 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10670 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10671 the "stick-table" statement.
10672
10673 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10674 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10675 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
10676 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
10677 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
10678 address.
10679
10680 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10681 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
10682 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
10683 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
10684 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
10685 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
10686 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
10687 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
10688 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
10689 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
10690
10691 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10692 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10693 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10694 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10695 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10696 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10697 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10698
10699 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
10700 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10701 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
10702 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10703
10704 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
10705 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10706 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10707 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10708 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10709 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010710 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
10711 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10712 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10713 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10714 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10715 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010716
10717 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
10718 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
10719 the request.
10720
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010721 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10722 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010723 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010724
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010725 Example :
10726 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10727 # last 30 minutes
10728 backend pop
10729 mode tcp
10730 balance roundrobin
10731 stick store-request src
10732 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10733 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10734 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10735
10736 backend smtp
10737 mode tcp
10738 balance roundrobin
10739 stick match src table pop
10740 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10741 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10742
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010743 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010744 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010745
10746
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010747stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070010748 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010749 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080010750 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010751 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010752 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010753
10754 Arguments :
10755 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
10756 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
10757 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10758 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10759
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010010760 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
10761 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
10762 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10763 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10764
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010765 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
10766 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
10767 instance.
10768
10769 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
10770 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
10771 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
10772 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
10773 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
10774 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010775 to 32 characters.
10776
10777 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
10778 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
10779 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010780 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010781 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
10782 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010783
10784 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010785 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
10786 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010787 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
10788 increase.
10789
10790 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010791 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
10792 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
10793 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010794
10795 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
10796 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
10797 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
10798 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010799 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010800 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
10801 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
10802 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
10803 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
10804 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
10805 parameter (see below).
10806
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010807 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
10808 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
10809 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
10810 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
10811 soft restart.
10812
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020010813 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
10814 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010815
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010816 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
10817 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
10818 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
10819 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010010820 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010821 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010822 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
10823 if not expiration delay is specified.
10824
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070010825 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
10826 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
10827 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
10828 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
10829 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
10830 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
10831 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
10832 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
10833 token.
10834
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010835 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
10836 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
10837 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
10838 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010839 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
10840 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
10841 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
10842 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
10843 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
10844 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
10845 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
10846 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
10847 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
10848 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
10849 types and their arguments.
10850
10851 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
10852 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
10853 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
10854 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
10855
10856 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10857 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10858 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010859 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010860
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010861 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10862 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10863 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010864 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010865 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010866 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010867
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010868 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10869 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10870 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
10871 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
10872
10873 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
10874 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10875 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
10876 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
10877 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
10878 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
10879
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010880 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10881 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
10882 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
10883 they were received.
10884
10885 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10886 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
10887 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
10888 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
10889 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
10890
10891 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10892 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10893 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10894 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
10895 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10896
10897 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10898 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
10899 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
10900
10901 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10902 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10903 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10904 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
10905 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10906
10907 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10908 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
10909 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
10910 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
10911 the client side.
10912
10913 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10914 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10915 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10916 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
10917 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
10918 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
10919 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
10920
10921 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10922 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
10923 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
10924 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
10925 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
10926 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010927 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010928
10929 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10930 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10931 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10932 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
10933 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
10934 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10935
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010010936 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10937 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
10938 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
10939 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
10940 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
10941
10942 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
10943 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10944 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10945 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
10946 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
10947 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10948
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010949 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010950 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010951 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
10952 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
10953
10954 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10955 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10956 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10957 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10958 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10959 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
10960 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
10961 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
10962 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
10963 recommended for better fairness.
10964
10965 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010966 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010967 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
10968 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
10969
10970 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
10971 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10972 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10973 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10974 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10975 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
10976 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
10977 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
10978 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
10979 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010980
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010981 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
10982 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010983 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
10984 reference it.
10985
10986 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
10987 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010010988 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
10989 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
10990 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010991
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010992 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
10993 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
10994 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
10995 something that can be ignored.
10996
10997 Example:
10998 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
10999 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
11000 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
11001 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
11002
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011003 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010011004 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011005
11006
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011007stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010011008 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011009 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11010 no | no | yes | yes
11011
11012 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011013 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011014 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011015 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011016 server is selected.
11017
11018 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11019 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11020 the "stick-table" statement.
11021
11022 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11023 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11024 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
11025 when the response is a SSL server hello.
11026
11027 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11028 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
11029 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
11030 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
11031 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
11032 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011033 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011034 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
11035 rules.
11036
11037 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11038 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11039 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11040 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11041 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11042 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11043 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11044
11045 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
11046 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11047 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
11048 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11049
11050 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
11051 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11052 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11053 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11054 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11055 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011056 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
11057 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11058 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11059 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11060 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11061 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
11062 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
11063 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
11064 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011065
11066 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
11067
11068 Example :
11069 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
11070 backend https
11071 mode tcp
11072 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011073 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011074 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011075
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011076 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
11077 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
11078
11079 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
11080 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11081 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
11082
11083 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
11084 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011085
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011086 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
11087 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
11088 # at offset 44.
11089
11090 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
11091 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
11092
11093 # Learn on response if server hello.
11094 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011095
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011096 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11097 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11098
11099 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
11100 extraction.
11101
11102
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011103tcp-check comment <string>
11104 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
11105 it fails.
11106 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11107 yes | no | yes | yes
11108
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011109 Arguments :
11110 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
11111 rule fails.
11112
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011113 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
11114 user-friendly error reporting.
11115
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011116 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
11117 "tcp-check expect".
11118
11119
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011120tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
11121 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011122 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011123 Opens a new connection
11124 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011125 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011126
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011127 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011128 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11129
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011130 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040011131 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011132
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011133 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011134 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
11135 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011136 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011137
11138 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011139
11140 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
11141
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020011142 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
11143
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011144 ssl opens a ciphered connection
11145
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020011146 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
11147
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020011148 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
11149 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
11150 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11151 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11152
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011153 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
11154 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
11155 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
11156 haproxy -vv.
11157
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011158 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011159
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011160 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11161 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11162 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11163
11164 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11165 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11166 of the sequence.
11167
11168 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11169 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11170 do.
11171
11172 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11173 unset-var or comment rules.
11174
11175 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011176 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11177 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11178 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11179 option tcp-check
11180 tcp-check connect
11181 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11182 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11183 tcp-check send \r\n
11184 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11185 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11186 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11187 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11188 tcp-check send \r\n
11189 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11190 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11191
11192 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11193 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011194 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011195 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11196 tcp-check connect port 143
11197 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11198 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11199
11200 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11201
11202
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011203tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011204 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011205 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011206 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011207 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011208 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011209 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011210
11211 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011212 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11213
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011214 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11215 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11216 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11217 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11218 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11219 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11220 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11221 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11222 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11223 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11224
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011225 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011226 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11227 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011228 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11229 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11230 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11231
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011232 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11233 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11234 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011235 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11236 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011237 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11238 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011239 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11240 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011241 By default "L7OK" is used.
11242
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011243 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11244 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011245 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11246 supported :
11247 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11248 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011249 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11250 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11251 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11252 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11253 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011254
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011255 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011256 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011257 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11258 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11259 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11260 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011261 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11262
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011263 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11264 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11265 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11266 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11267
11268 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11269 informational message reported in logs if an error
11270 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11271 log-format string.
11272
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011273 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11274 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11275 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11276 followed by some converters.
11277
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011278 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11279 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11280 with the usual backslash ('\').
11281 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011282 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011283 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11284 used upper or lower case.
11285
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011286 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11287
11288 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11289 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11290 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11291 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11292 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11293 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11294 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11295 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11296
11297 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11298 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11299 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11300 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11301 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11302 expression.
11303
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011304 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11305 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11306 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11307 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11308 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11309 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11310
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011311 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11312 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11313 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11314 this exact hexadecimal string.
11315 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11316
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011317 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11318 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11319 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11320 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11321 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11322 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11323 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11324 size.
11325
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011326 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11327 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11328 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11329 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11330 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11331 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11332 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11333 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11334 in a binary string before matching the response's
11335 buffer.
11336
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011337 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011338 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011339 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11340 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11341 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11342 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11343 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11344 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11345 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11346 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11347 the null character.
11348
11349 Examples :
11350 # perform a POP check
11351 option tcp-check
11352 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11353
11354 # perform an IMAP check
11355 option tcp-check
11356 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11357
11358 # look for the redis master server
11359 option tcp-check
11360 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011361 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011362 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11363 tcp-check expect string role:master
11364 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11365 tcp-check expect string +OK
11366
11367
11368 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011369 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011370
11371
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011372tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11373tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11374 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11375 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011376 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011377 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011378
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011379 Arguments :
11380 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11381
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011382 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11383 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011384
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011385 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11386 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011387
11388 Examples :
11389 # look for the redis master server
11390 option tcp-check
11391 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11392 tcp-check expect string role:master
11393
11394 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011395 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011396
11397
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011398tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11399tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11400 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11401 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011402 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011403 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011404
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011405 Arguments :
11406 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011407
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011408 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11409 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011410
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011411 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11412 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
11413 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011414
11415 Examples :
11416 # redis check in binary
11417 option tcp-check
11418 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
11419 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
11420
11421
11422 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011423 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011424
11425
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011426tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011427 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011428 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011429 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011430
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011431 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011432 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11433 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11434 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11435 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11436 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11437 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11438 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11439 and '-'.
11440
11441 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
11442
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011443 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011444 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
11445
11446
11447tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011448 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011449 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011450 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011451
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011452 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011453 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11454 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11455 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11456 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11457 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11458 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11459 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11460 and '-'.
11461
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011462 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011463 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
11464
11465
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011466tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11467 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011468 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11469 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011470 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011471 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11472 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011473
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011474 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011475
11476 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
11477 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011478 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
11479 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
11480 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
11481 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
11482 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
11483 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011484
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011485 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11486 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11487 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
11488 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011489
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011490 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011491 - accept :
11492 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11493 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11494 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011495
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011496 - reject :
11497 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11498 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11499 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
11500 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
11501 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
11502 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
11503 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
11504 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
11505 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
11506 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
11507 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011508 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011509
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011510 - expect-proxy layer4 :
11511 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
11512 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
11513 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
11514 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
11515 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
11516 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
11517 hosts.
11518
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011519 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
11520 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
11521 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
11522 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
11523 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
11524 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
11525 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
11526 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
11527
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011528 - capture <sample> len <length> :
11529 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
11530 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
11531 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
11532 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
11533 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
11534 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
11535 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
11536 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011537 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
11538 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011539
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011540 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011541 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011542 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
11543 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
11544 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011545 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020011546 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011547 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
11548 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
11549 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
11550 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
11551 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
11552 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
11553 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011554
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011555 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011556 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011557 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011558 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011559 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
11560 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
11561 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011562
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011563 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
11564 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
11565 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
11566 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011567
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011568 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
11569 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
11570 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
11571 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
11572 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011573 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
11574 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
11575 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
11576 layer7 information is extracted.
11577
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011578 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
11579 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
11580 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
11581 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
11582 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011583
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011584 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11585 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11586 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11587 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11588
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011589 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11590 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11591 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11592 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11593
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011594 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
11595 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11596 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11597 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11598 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011599
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011600 - set-src <expr> :
11601 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
11602 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
11603 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011604 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011605
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011606 Arguments:
11607 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11608 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011609
11610 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011611 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
11612
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011613 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
11614 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011615
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011616 - set-src-port <expr> :
11617 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
11618 expression.
11619
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011620 Arguments:
11621 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11622 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011623
11624 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011625 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
11626
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011627 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
11628 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
11629 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011630
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011631 - set-dst <expr> :
11632 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
11633 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
11634 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
11635 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11636 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11637
11638 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11639 followed by some converters.
11640
11641 Example:
11642
11643 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
11644 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
11645
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011646 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
11647 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
11648
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011649 - set-dst-port <expr> :
11650 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
11651 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11652 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11653
11654
11655 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11656 followed by some converters.
11657
11658 Example:
11659
11660 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
11661
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011662 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
11663 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
11664 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
11665
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011666 - "silent-drop" :
11667 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011668 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011669 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11670 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11671 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11672 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11673 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011674 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11675 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011676 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11677 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011678 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011679 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11680 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11681 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11682 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11683
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011684 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11685 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11686 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011687
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011688 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11689 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
11690 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011691
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011692 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011693 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011694 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011695
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011696 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
11697 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11698 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011699
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011700 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011701 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11702 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011703
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011704 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
11705
11706 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11707
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011708 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11709
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011710 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011711
11712
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011713tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11714 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011715 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011716 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011717 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011718 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11719 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011720
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011721 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011722
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011723 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011724 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11725 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
11726 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
11727 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011728
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011729 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
11730 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
11731 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
11732 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011733 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
11734 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
11735 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
11736 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
11737 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
11738 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011739 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011740 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011741
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011742 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11743 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11744 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11745 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011746
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011747 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011748 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011749 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011750 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11751 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011752 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011753 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011754 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011755 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011756 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011757 - set-dst <expr>
11758 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011759 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011760 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011761 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011762 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011763 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011764
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011765 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
11766 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011767 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
11768 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011769
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011770 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
11771 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
11772 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
11773 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
11774 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
11775 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011776
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011777 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011778 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11779 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011780
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020011781 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
11782 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
11783 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
11784 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
11785 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
11786 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
11787
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011788 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020011789 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
11790 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
11791 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
11792 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
11793 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
11794 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
11795 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
11796 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
11797 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
11798 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011799
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011800 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011801 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
11802 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
11803 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011804
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011805 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
11806 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
11807
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011808 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011809 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
11810 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011811
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011812 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11813 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011814 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011815 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11816 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011817 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011818 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011819 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011820 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11821 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011822 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011823 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11824 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011825
11826 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11827 followed by some converters.
11828
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011829 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11830 <var-name>.
11831
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011832 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
11833 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
11834 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
11835 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
11836 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
11837
11838 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
11839 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
11840 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
11841 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
11842 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
11843 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
11844 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
11845 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
11846 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
11847 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
11848 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
11849
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011850 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11851 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11852 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11853 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11854 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11855
11856 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11857
11858 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11859
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011860 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
11861 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
11862 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
11863 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
11864 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
11865 evaluated.
11866
11867 Example:
11868 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
11869
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011870 Example:
11871
11872 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011873 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011874
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011875 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011876 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
11877 # and reject everything else.
11878 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
11879 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020011880 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011881 tcp-request content reject
11882
11883 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011884 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
11885 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11886 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011887 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011888
11889 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
11890 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11891 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011892 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011893 tcp-request content reject
11894
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011895 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011896 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011897 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011898 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011899 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
11900 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011901
11902 Example:
11903 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11904 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011905 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011906
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011907 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011908 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011909
11910 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011911 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011912 # protecting all our sites
11913 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011914 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11915 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011916 ...
11917 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
11918
11919 backend http_dynamic
11920 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011921 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011922 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011923 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011924 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011925 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011926 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011927
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011928 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011929
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030011930 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
11931 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011932
11933
11934tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
11935 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
11936 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011937 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011938 Arguments :
11939 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11940 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11941 as explained at the top of this document.
11942
11943 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
11944 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
11945 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
11946 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
11947 data for at most the specified amount of time.
11948
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011949 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
11950 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
11951 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
11952 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
11953
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011954 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
11955 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011956 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011957 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010011958 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
11959 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
11960 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
11961 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011962
11963 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
11964 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
11965 it pass through unaffected.
11966
11967 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
11968 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
11969 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011970 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011971 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
11972 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020011973 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
11974 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
11975 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011976
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011977 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011978 "timeout client".
11979
11980
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011981tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11982 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
11983 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11984 no | no | yes | yes
11985 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011986 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11987 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011988
11989 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11990
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011991 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011992 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11993 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011994 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
11995 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011996
11997 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
11998
11999 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12000 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12001 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12002 inserted.
12003
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012004 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012005 - accept :
12006 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12007 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12008 the rules evaluation.
12009
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012010 - close :
12011 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
12012 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
12013 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
12014 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
12015 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
12016 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012017 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012018 protocols.
12019
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012020 - reject :
12021 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12022 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012023 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012024
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012025 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
12026 Sets a variable.
12027
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012028 - unset-var(<var-name>)
12029 Unsets a variable.
12030
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012031 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12032 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12033 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12034 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12035
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012036 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12037 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12038 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12039 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12040
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012041 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12042 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12043 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12044 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12045 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012046
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012047 - "silent-drop" :
12048 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012049 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012050 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12051 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12052 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12053 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12054 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012055 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12056 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012057 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12058 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012059 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012060 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12061 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12062 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12063 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12064
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012065 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12066 Send a group of SPOE messages.
12067
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012068 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12069 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12070 for changing the default action to a reject.
12071
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012072 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
12073 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
12074 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
12075 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012076 period.
12077
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012078 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
12079 declared inline.
12080
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012081 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12082 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012083 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012084 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12085 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012086 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012087 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012088 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012089 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12090 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012091 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012092 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12093 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012094
12095 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12096 followed by some converters.
12097
12098 Example:
12099
12100 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
12101
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012102 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12103 <var-name>.
12104
12105 Example:
12106
12107 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
12108
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012109 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12110 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12111 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12112 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12113 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12114
12115 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12116
12117 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12118
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012119 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12120
12121 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
12122
12123
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012124tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12125 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
12126 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12127 no | yes | yes | no
12128 Arguments :
12129 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12130 below.
12131
12132 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12133
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012134 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012135 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
12136 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
12137 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
12138 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
12139 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
12140 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
12141 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012142 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012143 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
12144 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
12145 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
12146 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
12147 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
12148 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
12149 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
12150 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
12151 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
12152 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
12153 instead.
12154
12155 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12156 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12157 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
12158 rules which may be inserted.
12159
12160 Several types of actions are supported :
12161 - accept : the request is accepted
12162 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12163 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
12164 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012165 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012166 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012167 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012168 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012169 - silent-drop
12170
12171 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
12172 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
12173 sections for a complete description.
12174
12175 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12176 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12177 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12178
12179 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12180 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12181 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12182 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12183 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12184
12185 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12186 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12187
12188 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12189 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12190 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12191
12192 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12193 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12194 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12195
12196 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12197 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12198 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12199
12200 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12201 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12202 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12203
12204 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12205
12206 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12207
12208
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012209tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12210 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12211 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12212 no | no | yes | yes
12213 Arguments :
12214 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12215 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12216 as explained at the top of this document.
12217
12218 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12219
12220
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012221timeout check <timeout>
12222 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12223 established.
12224
12225 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12226 yes | no | yes | yes
12227 Arguments:
12228 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12229 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12230 as explained at the top of this document.
12231
12232 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
12233 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012234 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012235 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012236 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12237 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12238 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012239
12240 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
12241 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12242
12243 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12244 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012245 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012246
12247 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12248 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12249 forget about it.
12250
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012251 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12252 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012253
12254
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012255timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012256 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12257 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12258 yes | yes | yes | no
12259 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012260 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012261 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12262 as explained at the top of this document.
12263
12264 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12265 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12266 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012267 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12268 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12269 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12270 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012271 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12272 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12273 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012274 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012275 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012276 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12277 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012278 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12279 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012280
12281 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12282 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12283 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12284 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012285 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012286 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12287
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012288 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012289
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012290 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012291
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012292
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012293timeout client-fin <timeout>
12294 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12295 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12296 yes | yes | yes | no
12297 Arguments :
12298 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12299 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12300 as explained at the top of this document.
12301
12302 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12303 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12304 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12305 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12306 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12307 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12308 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010012309 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
12310 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
12311 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012312
12313 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12314 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12315 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
12316
12317 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
12318
12319
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012320timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012321 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
12322 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12323 yes | no | yes | yes
12324 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012325 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012326 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12327 as explained at the top of this document.
12328
12329 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012330 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012331 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012332 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012333 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
12334 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012335
12336 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12337 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12338 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12339 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012340 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012341 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12342
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012343 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012344
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012345
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012346timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
12347 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
12348 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12349 yes | yes | yes | yes
12350 Arguments :
12351 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12352 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12353 as explained at the top of this document.
12354
12355 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
12356 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
12357 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
12358 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
12359 once the request has started to present itself.
12360
12361 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
12362 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
12363 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
12364 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
12365 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
12366
12367 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
12368 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
12369 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
12370 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
12371
12372 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
12373 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012374 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012375 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
12376 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012377 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012378
12379 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
12380 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
12381 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
12382 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
12383
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012384 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
12385 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012386 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
12387
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012388 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
12389
12390
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012391timeout http-request <timeout>
12392 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
12393 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012394 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012395 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012396 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012397 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12398 as explained at the top of this document.
12399
12400 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
12401 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
12402 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
12403 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
12404 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
12405 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
12406 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012407 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
12408 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
12409 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
12410 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012411 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012412 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
12413 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012414
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012415 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
12416 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
12417 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
12418 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
12419 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012420 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012421
12422 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
12423 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012424 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012425 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
12426 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
12427
12428 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012429 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
12430 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
12431 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012432
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012433 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012434 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012435
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012436
12437timeout queue <timeout>
12438 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
12439 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12440 yes | no | yes | yes
12441 Arguments :
12442 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12443 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12444 as explained at the top of this document.
12445
12446 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
12447 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
12448 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
12449 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
12450 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
12451
12452 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
12453 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
12454 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
12455 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
12456
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012457 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012458
12459
12460timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012461 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
12462 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12463 yes | no | yes | yes
12464 Arguments :
12465 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12466 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12467 as explained at the top of this document.
12468
12469 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12470 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12471 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
12472 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
12473 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
12474 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
12475 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
12476
12477 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12478 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12479 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
12480 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
12481 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012482 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012483 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012484 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
12485 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012486 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
12487 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012488
12489 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12490 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12491 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12492 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012493 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012494 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12495
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012496 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012497
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012498
12499timeout server-fin <timeout>
12500 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
12501 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12502 yes | no | yes | yes
12503 Arguments :
12504 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12505 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12506 as explained at the top of this document.
12507
12508 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12509 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12510 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12511 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12512 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
12513 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12514 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
12515 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
12516 situations, it should not be needed.
12517
12518 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12519 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12520 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
12521
12522 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
12523
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012524
12525timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012526 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012527 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12528 yes | yes | yes | yes
12529 Arguments :
12530 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
12531 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12532 as explained at the top of this document.
12533
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020012534 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
12535 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
12536 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012537
12538 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12539 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12540 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
12541 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012542 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012543
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012544 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012545
12546
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012547timeout tunnel <timeout>
12548 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
12549 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12550 yes | no | yes | yes
12551 Arguments :
12552 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12553 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12554 as explained at the top of this document.
12555
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012556 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012557 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
12558 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
12559 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012560 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
12561 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012562 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
12563 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
12564 specified.
12565
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012566 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
12567 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
12568 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
12569 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
12570 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
12571 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
12572 state.
12573
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012574 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12575 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12576 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
12577 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012578 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012579
12580 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12581 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12582 forget about it.
12583
12584 Example :
12585 defaults http
12586 option http-server-close
12587 timeout connect 5s
12588 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012589 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012590 timeout server 30s
12591 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
12592
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012593 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012594
12595
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012596transparent (deprecated)
12597 Enable client-side transparent proxying
12598 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010012599 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012600 Arguments : none
12601
12602 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
12603 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
12604 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
12605 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
12606 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
12607 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
12608 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
12609 appropriate server.
12610
12611 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
12612
12613 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
12614 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
12615
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012616 See also: "option transparent"
12617
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012618unique-id-format <string>
12619 Generate a unique ID for each request.
12620 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12621 yes | yes | yes | no
12622 Arguments :
12623 <string> is a log-format string.
12624
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012625 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
12626 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
12627 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
12628 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012629
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012630 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
12631 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
12632 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
12633 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
12634 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
12635 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
12636 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
12637 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012638
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012639 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
12640 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012641
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012642 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012643
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012644 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012645
12646 will generate:
12647
12648 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12649
12650 See also: "unique-id-header"
12651
12652unique-id-header <name>
12653 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
12654 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12655 yes | yes | yes | no
12656 Arguments :
12657 <name> is the name of the header.
12658
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012659 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
12660 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012661
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012662 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012663
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012664 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012665 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
12666
12667 will generate:
12668
12669 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12670
12671 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012672
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012673use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012674 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012675 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12676 no | yes | yes | no
12677 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012678 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
12679 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012680
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012681 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
12682 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012683
12684 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
12685 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
12686 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012687 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012688 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012689 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
12690 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012691
12692 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
12693 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
12694 assign the backend.
12695
12696 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
12697 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12698 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
12699 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
12700 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
12701 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
12702
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012703 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012704 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012705 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
12706 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
12707 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
12708
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012709 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
12710 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
12711 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
12712 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
12713 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
12714 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
12715 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
12716 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
12717 cannot be forced from the request.
12718
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012719 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012720 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
12721 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
12722
12723 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
12724 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012725
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012726use-fcgi-app <name>
12727 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
12728 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12729 no | no | yes | yes
12730 Arguments :
12731 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
12732
12733 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012734
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012735use-server <server> if <condition>
12736use-server <server> unless <condition>
12737 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
12738 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12739 no | no | yes | yes
12740 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012741 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
12742 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012743
12744 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
12745
12746 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
12747 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
12748 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
12749
12750 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
12751 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
12752 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
12753 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
12754 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
12755 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
12756 matches will assign the server.
12757
12758 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
12759 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
12760 with the next rules until one matches.
12761
12762 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
12763 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12764 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
12765 according to other persistence mechanisms.
12766
12767 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
12768 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
12769 stripped.
12770
12771 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
12772 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020012773 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
12774 implicit TLS (also see "req_ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
12775 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012776
12777 Example :
12778 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
12779 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
12780 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
12781 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020012782 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012783 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000012784 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012785 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
12786 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
12787
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012788 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
12789 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
12790 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
12791 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050012792 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012793 and we fall back to load balancing.
12794
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012795 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012796
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012797
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100127985. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012799--------------------------
12800
12801The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
12802depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
12803settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
12804written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
12805described in this section.
12806
12807
128085.1. Bind options
12809-----------------
12810
12811The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
12812as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
12813no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
12814parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
12815while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
12816provided immediately after the setting name.
12817
12818The currently supported settings are the following ones.
12819
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012820accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
12821 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
12822 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
12823 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
12824 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
12825 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
12826 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
12827 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
12828 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
12829 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010012830 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
12831 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
12832 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012833
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012834accept-proxy
12835 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020012836 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
12837 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012838 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
12839 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
12840 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
12841 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012842 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012843 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
12844 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012845 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
12846 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012847
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012848allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010012849 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012850 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012851 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012852 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
12853 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012854
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012855alpn <protocols>
12856 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12857 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12858 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012859 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012860 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012861 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
12862 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12863 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
12864 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
12865 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
12866 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
12867 preference, like below :
12868
12869 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012870
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012871backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010012872 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012873 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
12874
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010012875curves <curves>
12876 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12877 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
12878 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
12879 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
12880 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
12881 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
12882
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012883ecdhe <named curve>
12884 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010012885 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
12886 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012887
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012888ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012889 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12890 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12891 client's certificate.
12892
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012893ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
12894 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12895 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
12896 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
12897 error is ignored.
12898
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012899ca-sign-file <cafile>
12900 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12901 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
12902 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
12903 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12904 'generate-certificates' for details.
12905
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000012906ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012907 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
12908 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
12909 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12910 'generate-certificates' for details.
12911
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012912ca-verify-file <cafile>
12913 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
12914 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
12915 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
12916 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
12917 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
12918
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012919ciphers <ciphers>
12920 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12921 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000012922 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012923 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012924 information and recommendations see e.g.
12925 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12926 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12927 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
12928
12929ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12930 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12931 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
12932 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
12933 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012934 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
12935 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012936
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012937crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012938 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12939 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12940 to verify client's certificate.
12941
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012942crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012943 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12944 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
12945 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
12946 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
12947 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010012948 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
12949 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012950
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010012951 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
12952 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
12953
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012954 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
12955 are loaded.
12956
12957 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010012958 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
12959 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
12960 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
12961 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
12962 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
12963 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
12964 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012965 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012966
12967 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
12968 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
12969 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
12970 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010012971 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
12972 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012973
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020012974 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012975
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012976 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012977 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012978 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
12979 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012980 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
12981 clients).
12982
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020012983 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
12984 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
12985 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
12986 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
12987 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
12988 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
12989 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
12990 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
12991 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
12992 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
12993 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
12994 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
12995 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
12996
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012997 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
12998 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
12999 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
13000 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
13001 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
13002
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050013003 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
13004 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
13005 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
13006 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013007
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013008 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
13009 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
13010 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013011
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013012crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013013 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013014 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013015 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013016 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013017
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013018crt-list <file>
13019 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013020 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
13021 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013022
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013023 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
13024
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020013025 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
13026 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
13027 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
13028 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
13029 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013030
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013031 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013032 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
13033 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
13034 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
13035 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
13036 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013037 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
13038 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
13039 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013040
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013041 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
13042 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
13043 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013044
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013045 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
13046
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013047 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
13048 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which haproxy should use in
13049 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
13050 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
13051 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
13052 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
13053 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
13054 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013055
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013056 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013057 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013058 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013059 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013060 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013061 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013062
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013063defer-accept
13064 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13065 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
13066 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013067 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013068 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
13069 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
13070 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
13071 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
13072 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
13073 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
13074 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
13075
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013076expose-fd listeners
13077 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
13078 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020013079 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
13080 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013081 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013082
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013083force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013084 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013085 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013086 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013087 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013088
13089force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013090 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013091 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013092 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013093
13094force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013095 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013096 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013097 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013098
13099force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013100 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013101 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013102 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013103
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013104force-tlsv13
13105 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
13106 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013107 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013108
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013109generate-certificates
13110 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13111 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
13112 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
13113 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
13114 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
13115 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
13116 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
13117 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
13118 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
13119 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
13120 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
13121
13122 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
13123 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013124 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013125 certificate is used many times.
13126
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013127gid <gid>
13128 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
13129 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13130 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
13131 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
13132 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13133
13134group <group>
13135 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
13136 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
13137 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
13138 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
13139 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13140
13141id <id>
13142 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
13143 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
13144 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
13145 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
13146
13147interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010013148 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
13149 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
13150 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
13151 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
13152 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
13153 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010013154 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
13155 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
13156 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
13157 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
13158 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
13159 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013160
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013161level <level>
13162 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
13163 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
13164 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013165 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013166 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
13167 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
13168 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013169 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013170 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013171 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013172 all counters).
13173
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020013174severity-output <format>
13175 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
13176 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
13177 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13178 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13179 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13180 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13181 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13182 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13183 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13184 rfc5424 convention.
13185
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013186maxconn <maxconn>
13187 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13188 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13189 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13190 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13191 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13192 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13193 eat all memory.
13194
13195mode <mode>
13196 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13197 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13198 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13199 UNIX sockets.
13200
13201mss <maxseg>
13202 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13203 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13204 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13205 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13206 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13207 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13208 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13209 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13210 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13211 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13212 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13213
13214name <name>
13215 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13216 page.
13217
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013218namespace <name>
13219 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13220 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13221 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13222 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13223
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013224nice <nice>
13225 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13226 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13227 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13228 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13229 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13230 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13231 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13232 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13233 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13234 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13235 one for an RDP socket.
13236
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013237no-ca-names
13238 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13239 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013240 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013241
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013242no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013243 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013244 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013245 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013246 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013247 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13248 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013249
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013250no-tls-tickets
13251 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13252 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13253 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013254 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13255 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013256 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13257 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13258 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013259
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013260no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013261 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013262 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013263 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013264 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013265 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13266 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013267
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013268no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013269 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013270 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013271 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013272 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013273 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13274 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013275
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013276no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013277 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013278 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013279 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013280 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013281 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13282 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013283
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013284no-tlsv13
13285 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13286 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13287 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13288 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013289 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13290 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013291
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013292npn <protocols>
13293 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13294 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13295 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013296 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013297 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013298 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13299 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13300 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13301 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13302 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013303
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013304prefer-client-ciphers
13305 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13306 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13307 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020013308 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
13309 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
13310 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013311
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013312process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013313 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013314 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013315 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013316 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
13317 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
13318 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
13319 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013320 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013321 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
13322 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
13323 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
13324 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
13325 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013326
13327 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
13328
13329 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
13330 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
13331 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
13332 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
13333 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
13334 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
13335 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
13336 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020013337
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013338proto <name>
13339 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
13340 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
13341 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
13342 in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013343 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013344 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080013345 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013346 h2" on the bind line.
13347
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013348ssl
13349 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013350 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013351 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
13352 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020013353 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
13354 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013355
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013356ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13357 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013358 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
13359 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
13360 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013361 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13362
13363ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013364 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
13365 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
13366 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
13367 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013368
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010013369strict-sni
13370 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
13371 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
13372 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
13373 See the "crt" option for more information.
13374
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013375tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013376 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013377 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
13378 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013379 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013380 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
13381 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
13382 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
13383 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
13384 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
13385 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
13386 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13387
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013388tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010013389 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013390 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
13391 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
13392 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
13393 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
13394 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
13395 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
13396 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020013397 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
13398 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
13399 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013400
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013401tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
13402 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010013403 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
13404 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
13405 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
13406 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
13407 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
13408 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
13409 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
13410 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
13411 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
13412 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013413 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
13414 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
13415
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013416transparent
13417 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13418 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
13419 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
13420 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
13421 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
13422 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
13423 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
13424 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
13425 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
13426 so check for support with your vendor.
13427
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013428v4v6
13429 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13430 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
13431 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
13432 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013433 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013434
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013435v6only
13436 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13437 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
13438 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013439 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
13440 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013441
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013442uid <uid>
13443 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
13444 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13445 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
13446 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
13447 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13448
13449user <user>
13450 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
13451 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13452 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
13453 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
13454 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13455
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013456verify [none|optional|required]
13457 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
13458 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
13459 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
13460 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
13461 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013462 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
13463 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
13464 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
13465 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013466
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200134675.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013468------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013469
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013470The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
13471which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
13472arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
13473settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
13474after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
13475Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
13476address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013477
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013478 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013479 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013480
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013481Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
13482keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
13483
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013484The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013485
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013486addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013487 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010013488 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
13489 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
13490 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
13491 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
13492 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013493
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013494agent-check
13495 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013496 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010013497 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
13498 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
13499 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013500
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013501 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013502 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020013503 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
13504 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
13505 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013506
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013507 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
13508 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
13509 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
13510 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
13511 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020013512
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013513 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013514 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013515
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013516 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13517 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
13518 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013519
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013520 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13521 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
13522 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013523
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020013524 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013525 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
13526 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
13527 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
13528 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013529 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013530 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013531
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013532 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
13533 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013534
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013535 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
13536 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
13537 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
13538 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
13539 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
13540 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
13541 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
13542 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
13543 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013544
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013545 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
13546 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013547 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
13548 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
13549 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010013550 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013551
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013552 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013553 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013554
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070013555agent-send <string>
13556 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
13557 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
13558 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
13559 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
13560 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
13561
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013562agent-inter <delay>
13563 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
13564 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13565
13566 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
13567 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
13568 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
13569 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
13570 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13571 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13572 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13573 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13574 of backends use the same servers.
13575
13576 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
13577
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010013578agent-addr <addr>
13579 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
13580
13581 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
13582 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
13583 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
13584 hostname, it will be resolved.
13585
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013586agent-port <port>
13587 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
13588
13589 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
13590
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013591allow-0rtt
13592 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020013593 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
13594 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013595
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013596alpn <protocols>
13597 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13598 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13599 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013600 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013601 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
13602 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
13603 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13604 now obsolete NPN extension.
13605 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
13606 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
13607
13608 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
13609
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013610backup
13611 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
13612 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
13613 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
13614 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013615 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
13616 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013617
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013618ca-file <cafile>
13619 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13620 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13621 server's certificate.
13622
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013623check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013624 This option enables health checks on a server:
13625 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
13626 considered available.
13627 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
13628 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
13629 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
13630 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
13631 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
13632 set.
13633 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
13634 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
13635 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
13636 exchanges succeed.
13637
13638 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
13639 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
13640 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
13641 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
13642 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050013643 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013644 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
13645
13646 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
13647 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
13648
13649 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
13650 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
13651
13652 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
13653 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
13654 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
13655 available.
13656
13657 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
13658 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
13659 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
13660
13661 Example:
13662 # simple tcp check
13663 backend foo
13664 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
13665 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
13666 backend foo
13667 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
13668 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
13669 backend foo
13670 option tcp-check
13671 tcp-check connect
13672 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013673
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020013674check-send-proxy
13675 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
13676 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
13677 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
13678 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
13679 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
13680 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
13681 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
13682
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010013683check-alpn <protocols>
13684 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
13685 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
13686 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
13687
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013688check-proto <name>
13689 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
13690 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
13691 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
13692 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013693 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013694 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
13695 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
13696
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013697check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013698 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013699 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
13700 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013701
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013702check-ssl
13703 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
13704 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
13705 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
13706 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013707 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013708 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
13709 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013710 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013711 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
13712 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013713
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013714check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013715 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013716 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
13717 for normal traffic.
13718
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013719ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013720 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
13721 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
13722 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013723 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
13724 information and recommendations see e.g.
13725 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13726 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13727 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013728
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013729ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13730 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13731 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
13732 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
13733 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013734 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
13735 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
13736 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013737
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013738cookie <value>
13739 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
13740 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
13741 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
13742 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
13743 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
13744 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
13745 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
13746
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013747crl-file <crlfile>
13748 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13749 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
13750 to verify server's certificate.
13751
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020013752crt <cert>
13753 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13754 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
13755 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
13756 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
13757 certificate request.
13758
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013759disabled
13760 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
13761 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
13762 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
13763 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
13764 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013765 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013766
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013767enabled
13768 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
13769 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
13770 default value.
13771 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
13772 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013773
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013774error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010013775 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
13776 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
13777 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013778
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013779 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013780
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013781fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013782 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
13783 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
13784 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
13785
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013786force-sslv3
13787 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13788 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013789 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013790 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013791
13792force-tlsv10
13793 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013794 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013795 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013796
13797force-tlsv11
13798 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013799 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013800 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013801
13802force-tlsv12
13803 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013804 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013805 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013806
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013807force-tlsv13
13808 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13809 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013810 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013811
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013812id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020013813 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
13814 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
13815 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013816
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013817init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
13818 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
13819 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013820 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013821 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
13822 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
13823 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
13824 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
13825 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
13826 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
13827 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
13828 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
13829 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013830 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013831 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
13832 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
13833 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
13834 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
13835 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
13836 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013837 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013838
13839 Example:
13840 defaults
13841 # never fail on address resolution
13842 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
13843
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013844inter <delay>
13845fastinter <delay>
13846downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013847 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
13848 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13849 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
13850 between checks depending on the server state :
13851
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020013852 Server state | Interval used
13853 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13854 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
13855 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13856 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
13857 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
13858 or yet unchecked. |
13859 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13860 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
13861 | "inter" otherwise.
13862 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013863
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013864 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
13865 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
13866 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
13867 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013868 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13869 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13870 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13871 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13872 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013873
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020013874log-proto <logproto>
13875 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
13876 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
13877 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
13878 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
13879
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013880maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013881 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
13882 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013883 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
13884 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013885 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
13886 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
13887 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
13888 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
13889
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013890 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
13891 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
13892 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
13893 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
13894 than 50 concurrent requests.
13895
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013896maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013897 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
13898 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
13899 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
13900 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020013901 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
13902 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
13903 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
13904 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
13905 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
13906 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
13907 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013908
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010013909max-reuse <count>
13910 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
13911 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
13912 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
13913 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
13914 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
13915 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
13916 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
13917 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
13918
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013919minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013920 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
13921 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
13922 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
13923 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
13924 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
13925 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013926 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013927 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013928
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013929namespace <name>
13930 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13931 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
13932 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13933 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13934
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013935no-agent-check
13936 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
13937 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13938 default value.
13939 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13940 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
13941
13942no-backup
13943 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
13944 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13945 default value.
13946 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13947 "default-server" "backup" setting.
13948
13949no-check
13950 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
13951 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13952 default value.
13953 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13954 "default-server" "check" setting.
13955
13956no-check-ssl
13957 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
13958 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13959 default value.
13960 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13961 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
13962
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013963no-send-proxy
13964 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
13965 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13966 default value.
13967 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13968 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
13969
13970no-send-proxy-v2
13971 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
13972 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13973 default value.
13974 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13975 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
13976
13977no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
13978 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
13979 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13980 default value.
13981 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13982 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
13983
13984no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13985 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
13986 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13987 default value.
13988 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13989 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
13990
13991no-ssl
13992 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
13993 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13994 default value.
13995 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13996 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
13997
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010013998 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
13999 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
14000 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
14001
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010014002no-ssl-reuse
14003 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
14004 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
14005 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
14006 and for paranoid users.
14007
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014008no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014009 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14010 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014011 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014012
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014013 Supported in default-server: No
14014
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014015no-tls-tickets
14016 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14017 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14018 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014019 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
14020 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014021 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14022 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14023 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014024 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014025
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014026no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014027 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014028 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14029 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014030 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14031 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014032 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014033
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014034 Supported in default-server: No
14035
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014036no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014037 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014038 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14039 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014040 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14041 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014042 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014043
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014044 Supported in default-server: No
14045
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014046no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014047 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014048 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14049 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014050 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14051 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014052 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014053
14054 Supported in default-server: No
14055
14056no-tlsv13
14057 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14058 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14059 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
14060 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14061 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014062 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014063
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014064 Supported in default-server: No
14065
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014066no-verifyhost
14067 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
14068 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14069 default value.
14070 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14071 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014072
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014073no-tfo
14074 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
14075 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14076 default value.
14077 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14078 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
14079
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090014080non-stick
14081 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
14082 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
14083 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
14084
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014085npn <protocols>
14086 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14087 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14088 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014089 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014090 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
14091 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14092 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
14093
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014094observe <mode>
14095 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
14096 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
14097 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
14098 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
14099 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
14100 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010014101 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014102
14103 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
14104
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014105on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014106 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
14107 Currently, four modes are available:
14108 - fastinter: force fastinter
14109 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
14110 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
14111 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
14112 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
14113
14114 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
14115
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014116on-marked-down <action>
14117 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
14118 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014119 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
14120 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
14121 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
14122 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
14123 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
14124 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
14125 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
14126 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014127
14128 Actions are disabled by default
14129
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014130on-marked-up <action>
14131 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
14132 Currently one action is available:
14133 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
14134 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
14135 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
14136 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014137 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
14138 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014139 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
14140 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
14141
14142 Actions are disabled by default
14143
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014144pool-low-conn <max>
14145 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
14146 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
14147 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
14148 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
14149 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
14150 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
14151 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
14152 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
14153 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
14154 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010014155 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
14156 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
14157 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
14158 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014159
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010014160pool-max-conn <max>
14161 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
14162 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
14163 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
14164 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
14165 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
14166 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
14167
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014168pool-purge-delay <delay>
14169 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010014170 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020014171 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014172
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014173port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014174 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010014175 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14176 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
14177 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
14178 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
14179 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014180
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014181proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014182 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
14183 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
14184 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
14185 reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014186 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014187 protocol for all connections established to this server.
14188
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014189redir <prefix>
14190 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
14191 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
14192 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
14193 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
14194 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
14195 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14196 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14197 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014198 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014199 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014200 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14201 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14202 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14203 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14204
14205 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14206
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014207rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014208 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14209 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14210 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14211
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014212resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14213 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14214 server.
14215
14216 Available options:
14217
14218 * allow-dup-ip
14219 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14220 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14221 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14222 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14223 For such case, simply enable this option.
14224 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14225
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014226 * ignore-weight
14227 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14228 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
14229 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
14230
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014231 * prevent-dup-ip
14232 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
14233 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
14234 same fqdn.
14235 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
14236
14237 Example:
14238 backend b_myapp
14239 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
14240 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14241 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14242
14243 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
14244 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
14245 it
14246 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
14247 different address
14248
14249 Default value: not set
14250
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014251resolve-prefer <family>
14252 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
14253 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
14254 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
14255 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
14256
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020014257 Default value: ipv6
14258
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014259 Example:
14260
14261 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014262
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014263resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014264 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014265 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014266 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014267 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
14268 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014269 configured network, another address is selected.
14270
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014271 Example:
14272
14273 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014274
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014275resolvers <id>
14276 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
14277 hostname.
14278
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014279 Example:
14280
14281 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014282
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014283 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014284
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014285send-proxy
14286 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
14287 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
14288 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
14289 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014290 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
14291 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
14292 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
14293 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
14294 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
14295 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
14296 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
14297 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
14298 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
14299 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014300 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
14301 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014302
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014303send-proxy-v2
14304 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
14305 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14306 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14307 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020014308 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
14309 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
14310 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
14311 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014312
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014313proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010014314 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
14315 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
14316
14317 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
14318 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
14319 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
14320 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
14321 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
14322 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
14323 connection is supported).
14324 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
14325 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
14326 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
14327 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
14328 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
14329 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
14330 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014331
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014332send-proxy-v2-ssl
14333 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14334 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14335 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14336 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14337 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14338 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
14339 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014340 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
14341 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014342
14343send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14344 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14345 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14346 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14347 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14348 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14349 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
14350 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
14351 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014352 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
14353 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014354
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014355slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014356 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
14357 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
14358 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
14359 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
14360 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
14361 parameters :
14362
14363 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
14364 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
14365
14366 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
14367 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
14368 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
14369 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
14370
14371 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
14372 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
14373 seen as failed.
14374
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014375sni <expression>
14376 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
14377 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
14378 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
14379 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020014380 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
14381 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014382 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010014383 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
14384 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014385
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014386source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020014387source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014388source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014389 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
14390 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
14391 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
14392 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
14393
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014394 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
14395 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
14396 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
14397 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
14398 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
14399 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
14400 server.
14401
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000014402 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
14403 specifying the source address without port(s).
14404
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014405ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020014406 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
14407 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
14408 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
14409 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
14410 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
14411 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014412 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
14413 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014414
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014415ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14416 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
14417 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14418 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
14419
14420ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14421 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
14422 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14423 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
14424
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014425ssl-reuse
14426 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
14427 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14428 default value.
14429 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14430 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
14431
14432stick
14433 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
14434 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14435 default value.
14436 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14437 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014438
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014439socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014440 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014441 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
14442 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
14443
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014444tcp-ut <delay>
14445 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
14446 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
14447 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014448 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014449 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
14450 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
14451 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
14452 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
14453 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
14454 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
14455 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
14456 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
14457 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
14458
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014459tfo
14460 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
14461 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
14462 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
14463 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
14464 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014465 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014466
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014467track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020014468 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
14469 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
14470 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
14471 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014472 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
14473
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014474tls-tickets
14475 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
14476 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14477 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014478 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14479 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14480 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014481 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010014482 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014483
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014484verify [none|required]
14485 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010014486 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014487 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
14488 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014489 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014490 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
14491 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
14492 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
14493 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
14494 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
14495 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
14496 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
14497 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014498
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014499verifyhost <hostname>
14500 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014501 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
14502 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
14503 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
14504 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
14505 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
14506 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
14507 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
14508 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014509
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014510weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014511 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
14512 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
14513 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020014514 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
14515 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
14516 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
14517 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
14518 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
14519 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014520
14521
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200145225.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
14523-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014524
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014525HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
14526using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070014527configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014528This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
14529can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
14530workload.
14531This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
14532resolution at run time.
14533Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
14534carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
14535
14536
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200145375.3.1. Global overview
14538----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014539
14540As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
14541different steps of the process life:
14542
14543 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
14544 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
14545 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
14546
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014547 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
14548 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014549
14550A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
14551 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
14552 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
14553 resolution to know this new IP.
14554
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014555When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014556HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014557SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
14558from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
14559will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
14560will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020014561
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014562A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014563 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014564 first valid response.
14565
14566 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
14567 servers return an error.
14568
14569
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200145705.3.2. The resolvers section
14571----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014572
14573This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014574HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
14575contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014576
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014577When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
14578uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
14579is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
14580answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
14581
14582When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014583used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014584
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014585 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
14586 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
14587 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014588
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014589 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
14590 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014591
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014592 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
14593 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
14594 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014595
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014596For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
14597following scenarios are possible:
14598
14599 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
14600 ignored
14601
14602 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
14603 applied
14604
14605 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
14606 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
14607
14608 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
14609 retries the query with a new type
14610
14611 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
14612 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014613
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014614As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
14615a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014616<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014617
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014618
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014619resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014620 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014621
14622A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
14623
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014624accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014625 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014626 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014627 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
14628 by RFC 6891)
14629
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020014630 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
14631
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014632nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010014633 UDP DNS server description:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014634 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
14635 <ip> : IP address of the server
14636 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
14637
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010014638server <name> <address> [param*]
14639 Used to configure a DNS TCP or stream server. This supports for all
14640 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of these parameters
14641 are irrelevant for DNS resolving. Note: currently 4 queries are pipelined
14642 on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed every
14643 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
14644 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
14645
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014646parse-resolv-conf
14647 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
14648 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
14649 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
14650
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014651hold <status> <period>
14652 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
14653 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014654 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014655 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014656 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
14657 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14658 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
14659
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020014660 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014661
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014662resolve_retries <nb>
14663 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
14664 giving up.
14665 Default value: 3
14666
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014667 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
14668 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
14669 type.
14670
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014671timeout <event> <time>
14672 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
14673 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
14674 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014675 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
14676 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014677 Default value: 1s
14678 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014679 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014680 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014681 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14682 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
14683
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014684 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014685
14686 resolvers mydns
14687 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
14688 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014689 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014690 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014691 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014692 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014693 hold other 30s
14694 hold refused 30s
14695 hold nx 30s
14696 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014697 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014698 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014699
14700
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200147016. Cache
14702---------
14703
14704HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
14705(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
14706RAM.
14707
14708The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
14709this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
14710
14711If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
14712independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
14713when we try to allocate a new one.
14714
14715The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
14716
14717It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
14718"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
14719for more details.
14720
14721When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
14722replaced by "<CACHE>".
14723
14724
147256.1. Limitation
14726----------------
14727
14728The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
14729
14730- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010014731- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
14732 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
14733 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014734- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
14735- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010014736- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
14737 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
14738 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010014739- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
14740 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010014741- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
14742 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
14743 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014744
14745- If the request is not a GET
14746- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
14747- If the request contains an Authorization header
14748
14749
147506.2. Setup
14751-----------
14752
14753To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
14754the corresponding http-request and response actions.
14755
14756
147576.2.1. Cache section
14758---------------------
14759
14760cache <name>
14761 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
14762 size of cache is mandatory.
14763
14764total-max-size <megabytes>
14765 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
14766 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
14767
14768max-object-size <bytes>
14769 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
14770 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
14771 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
14772
14773max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010014774 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014775 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
14776 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
14777 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
14778 default.
14779
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010014780process-vary <on/off>
14781 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010014782 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
14783 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
14784 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010014785 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010014786
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010014787max-secondary-entries <number>
14788 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
14789 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
14790 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
14791
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014792
147936.2.2. Proxy section
14794---------------------
14795
14796http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14797 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
14798 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
14799 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
14800 after this one.
14801
14802http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14803 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
14804 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
14805 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
14806 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
14807
14808
14809Example:
14810
14811 backend bck1
14812 mode http
14813
14814 http-request cache-use foobar
14815 http-response cache-store foobar
14816 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
14817
14818 cache foobar
14819 total-max-size 4
14820 max-age 240
14821
14822
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200148237. Using ACLs and fetching samples
14824----------------------------------
14825
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014826HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014827client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
14828The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
14829these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
14830but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
14831data called patterns.
14832
14833
148347.1. ACL basics
14835---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014836
14837The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
14838content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
14839from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
14840simple :
14841
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014842 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014843 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014844 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
14845 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014846
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014847The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
14848adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014849
14850In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
14851
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014852 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014853
14854This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
14855Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
14856and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014857an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
14858conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
14859as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
14860are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014861
14862ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
14863'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
14864which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
14865
14866There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
14867performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
14868
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014869The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
14870specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
14871this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014872methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
14873ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014874
14875Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
14876 - boolean
14877 - integer (signed or unsigned)
14878 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
14879 - string
14880 - data block
14881
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014882Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
14883converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
14884would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
14885The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
14886which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
14887
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014888Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
14889keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
14890fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
14891which are summarized in the table below :
14892
14893 +---------------------+-----------------+
14894 | Sample or converter | Default |
14895 | output type | matching method |
14896 +---------------------+-----------------+
14897 | boolean | bool |
14898 +---------------------+-----------------+
14899 | integer | int |
14900 +---------------------+-----------------+
14901 | ip | ip |
14902 +---------------------+-----------------+
14903 | string | str |
14904 +---------------------+-----------------+
14905 | binary | none, use "-m" |
14906 +---------------------+-----------------+
14907
14908Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
14909matching method, see below.
14910
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014911The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
14912 - boolean
14913 - integer or integer range
14914 - IP address / network
14915 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
14916 - regular expression
14917 - hex block
14918
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014919The following ACL flags are currently supported :
14920
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014921 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
14922 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014923 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014924 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014925 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014926 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014927 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
14928
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014929The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
14930read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
14931if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
14932lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
14933will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
14934beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
14935a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
14936lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
14937exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
14938
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014939The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
14940parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
14941ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
14942a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
14943check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
14944
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014945The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
14946socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
14947file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
14948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014949Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
14950loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
14951
14952 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
14953
14954In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
14955the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
14956case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
14957as well.
14958
14959The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
14960sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
14961do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
14962methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
14963is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014964obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014965followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
14966default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
14967that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
14968string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
14969
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014970The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
14971By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
14972string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
14973resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
14974server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014975waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014976flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
14977function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
14978
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014979There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
14980sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
14981be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014982
14983 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
14984 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014985 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
14986 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
14987 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
14988 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014989
14990 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
14991 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014992 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014993
14994 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014995 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014996
14997 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014998 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014999
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015000 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015001 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
15002
15003 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
15004 binary or string samples.
15005
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015006 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
15007 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015008
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015009 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
15010 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
15011 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015012
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015013 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
15014 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015015
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015016 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
15017 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015018
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015019 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
15020 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015022 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
15023 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015024 This may be used with binary or string samples.
15025
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015026 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
15027 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
15028 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015029
15030For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
15031request, it is possible to do :
15032
15033 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
15034
15035In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
15036buffer, one would use the following acl :
15037
15038 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
15039
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015040On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
15041possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
15042
15043 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
15044
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015045All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
15046criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
15047method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
15048to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
15049criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
15050the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015051
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015052If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015053the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
15054For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015055
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015056 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
15057 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
15058 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
15059 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015060
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015061
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015062The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
15063types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
15064combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
15065brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
15066default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015067
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015068 +-------------------------------------------------+
15069 | Input sample type |
15070 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015071 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015072 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15073 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
15074 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015075 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015076 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015077 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015078 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015079 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015080 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015081 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015082 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015083 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015084 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015085 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015086 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015087 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015088 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015089 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015090 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015091 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015092 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015093 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015094 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015095 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015096 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15097 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
15098 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015099
15100
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200151017.1.1. Matching booleans
15102------------------------
15103
15104In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
15105Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
15106When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
15107that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
15108
15109Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
15110return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
15111"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
15112
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015113
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200151147.1.2. Matching integers
15115------------------------
15116
15117Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
15118enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
15119to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
15120
15121Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
15122matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
15123lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015124
15125For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
15126unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
15127representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
15128
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015129As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
15130two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
15131instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
15132ranges and operators.
15133
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015134For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015135operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
15136Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
15137of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015138
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015139Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015140
15141 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
15142 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
15143 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
15144 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
15145 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
15146
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015147For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015148
15149 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
15150
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015151This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
15152
15153 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
15154
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015155
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200151567.1.3. Matching strings
15157-----------------------
15158
15159String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
15160different forms :
15161
15162 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015163 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015164
15165 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015166 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015167
15168 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
15169 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15170
15171 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
15172 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15173
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010015174 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015175 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
15176 matches.
15177
15178 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
15179 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
15180 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015181
15182String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
15183exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
15184characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
15185string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
15186to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015187before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015188
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010015189Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
15190(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
15191Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
15192
15193Example:
15194 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
15195 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
15196
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015197
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200151987.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
15199---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015200
15201Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
15202they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
15203possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
15204passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
15205the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015206the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
15207match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015208
15209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200152107.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
15211-------------------------------------
15212
15213It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
15214not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
15215a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
15216to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
15217digits may be used upper or lower case.
15218
15219Example :
15220 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
15221 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
15222
15223
152247.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
15225---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015226
15227IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
15228netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
15229within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010015230host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015231difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
15232at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
15233does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
15234parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015235
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020015236The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
15237abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
15238
15239 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15240 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
15241 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15242 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
15243 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
15244 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
15245 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
15246 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15247
15248Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
15249192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
15250
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015251IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
15252Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
15253trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
15254IPv6 patterns.
15255
15256HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
15257following situations :
15258 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
15259 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
15260 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
15261 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
15262 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
15263 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
15264 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
15265 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
15266 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
15267 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
15268
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015269
152707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
15271----------------------------------
15272
15273Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
15274combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
15275
15276 - AND (implicit)
15277 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
15278 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015279
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015280A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015281
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015282 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015283
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015284Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
15285indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015286
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015287For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
15288"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
15289requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
15290is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
15291
15292 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015293 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
15294 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
15295 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015296
15297To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
15298and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
15299
15300 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
15301 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
15302 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
15303 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
15304
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015305 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015306 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
15307 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
15308 use_backend www if host_www
15309
15310It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
15311expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
15312be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
15313the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
15314
15315 The following rule :
15316
15317 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015318 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015319
15320 Can also be written that way :
15321
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015322 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015323
15324It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
15325to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
15326simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
15327sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
15328good use is the following :
15329
15330 With named ACLs :
15331
15332 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
15333 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
15334 monitor fail if site_dead
15335
15336 With anonymous ACLs :
15337
15338 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
15339
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015340See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
15341keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015342
15343
153447.3. Fetching samples
15345---------------------
15346
15347Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
15348against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
15349sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
15350ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
15351of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
15352available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
15353
15354This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
15355Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
15356compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
15357deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
15358
15359The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
15360matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
15361method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
15362indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
15363
15364As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
15365when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
15366mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
15367the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
15368ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
15369
15370Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
15371multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
15372when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015373incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
15374are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015375is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
15376all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
15377
15378Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
15379 - name
15380 - name(arg1)
15381 - name(arg1,arg2)
15382
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015383
153847.3.1. Converters
15385-----------------
15386
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015387Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
15388of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
15389is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
15390was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015391has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015392unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
15393
15394These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
15395sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
15396the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015397support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015398
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015399A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
15400support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
15401supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
15402(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
15403bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
15404
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015405The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015406
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001540751d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
15408 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15409 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15410 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
15411 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15412 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15413
15414 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015415 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
15416 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000015417 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
15418 frontend http-in
15419 bind *:8081
15420 default_backend servers
15421 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15422 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15423
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015424add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015425 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015426 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015427 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
15428 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015429 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015430 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15431 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15432 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15433 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015434 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015435 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015436
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010015437aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
15438 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
15439 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
15440 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
15441 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
15442 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
15443 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
15444
15445 Example:
15446 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
15447 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
15448
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015449and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015450 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015451 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015452 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15453 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015454 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015455 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15456 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15457 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15458 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015459 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015460 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015461
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020015462b64dec
15463 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
15464 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
15465
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015466base64
15467 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015468 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015469 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
15470
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015471bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015472 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015473 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015474 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015475 presence of a flag).
15476
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015477bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
15478 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
15479 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015480 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015481
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015482concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
15483 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
15484 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
15485 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
15486 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
15487 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
15488 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
15489 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
15490 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
15491 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
15492 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015493 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015494 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015495 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
15496 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015497
15498 Example:
15499 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
15500 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
15501 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015502 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015503 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
15504
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015505cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015506 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
15507 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015508
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015509crc32([<avalanche>])
15510 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
15511 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15512 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15513 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15514 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15515 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
15516 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
15517 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
15518 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
15519 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015520 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
15521
15522crc32c([<avalanche>])
15523 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
15524 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15525 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15526 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
15527 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
15528 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
15529 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
15530 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015531
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020015532cut_crlf
15533 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
15534 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
15535 updated.
15536
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010015537da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015538 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
15539 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
15540 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
15541 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015542 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015543 configuration language.
15544
15545 Example:
15546 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015547 bind *:8881
15548 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015549 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015550
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010015551debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
15552 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
15553 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
15554 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
15555 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
15556 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
15557 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
15558 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
15559 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
15560 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
15561 printable sample types.
15562
15563 Example:
15564 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020015565
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015566digest(<algorithm>)
15567 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
15568 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
15569
15570 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15571 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15572
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015573div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015574 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15575 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015576 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015577 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
15578 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015579 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015580 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15581 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15582 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15583 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015584 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015585 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015586
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015587djb2([<avalanche>])
15588 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
15589 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15590 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15591 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15592 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15593 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15594 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015595 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
15596 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015597
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015598even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015599 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015600 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
15601
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015602field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15603 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
15604 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
15605 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
15606 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
15607 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
15608 fields.
15609
15610 Example :
15611 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
15612 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15613 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
15614 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
15615 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010015616
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020015617fix_is_valid
15618 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
15619 Information eXchange):
15620
15621 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
15622 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050015623 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020015624 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
15625 - checks the MstType tag is the third tag.
15626 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
15627 checksum
15628
15629 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15630 the server can be parsed.
15631
15632 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
15633 message, false if not.
15634
15635 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
15636
15637 Example:
15638 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15639 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
15640
15641fix_tag_value(<tag>)
15642 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
15643 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
15644 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
15645 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
15646 MsgType, SenderComID, TargetComID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
15647 added.
15648
15649 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15650 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
15651 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
15652 fix_is_valid converter.
15653
15654 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
15655
15656 Example:
15657 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15658 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
15659 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
15660 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
15661 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
15662
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015663hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015664 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015665 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015666 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015667 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010015668
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015669hex2i
15670 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015671 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015672
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020015673htonl
15674 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
15675 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
15676 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
15677 unsigned 32-bit integer.
15678
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010015679hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015680 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
15681 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
15682 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
15683 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
15684
15685 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15686 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15687
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010015688http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015689 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15690 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015691 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
15692 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
15693 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
15694 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
15695 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
15696 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
15697 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
15698 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015699
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020015700iif(<true>,<false>)
15701 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
15702 string otherwise.
15703
15704 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020015705 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020015706
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015707in_table(<table>)
15708 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15709 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
15710 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015711 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015712 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
15713
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010015714ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015715 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015716 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015717 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
15718 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
15719 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
15720 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
15721 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015722
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015723json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015724 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015725 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015726 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015727 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
15728 of errors:
15729 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
15730 bytes, ...)
15731 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
15732 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
15733
15734 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
15735 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
15736 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
15737 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
15738 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
15739 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015740 - "ascii" : never fails;
15741 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
15742 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015743 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015744 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015745 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
15746 characters corresponding to the other errors.
15747
15748 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015749 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015750
15751 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015752 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015753 capture request header user-agent len 150
15754 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015755
15756 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
15757 GET / HTTP/1.0
15758 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
15759
15760 Output log:
15761 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
15762
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015763language(<value>[,<default>])
15764 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
15765 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
15766 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
15767 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
15768 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
15769 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
15770 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
15771 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
15772 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015773 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015774 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
15775 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015776
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015777 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015778
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015779 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
15780 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015781
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015782 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
15783 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
15784 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
15785 use_backend spanish if es
15786 use_backend french if fr
15787 use_backend english if en
15788 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015789
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010015790length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010015791 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
15792 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15793 type. The result is of type integer.
15794
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015795lower
15796 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
15797 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15798 type. The result is of type string.
15799
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015800ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
15801 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15802 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
15803 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
15804 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
15805 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
15806 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
15807
15808 Example :
15809
15810 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015811 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015812 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
15813
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020015814ltrim(<chars>)
15815 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
15816 representation of the input sample.
15817
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015818map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15819map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15820map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15821 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
15822 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
15823 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
15824 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
15825 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
15826 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
15827 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
15828 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015829
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015830 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
15831 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
15832 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015833
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015834 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015835 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015836
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015837 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
15838 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15839 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
15840 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020015841 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
15842 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015843 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
15844 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15845 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
15846 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15847 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
15848 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15849 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
15850 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080015851 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
15852 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15853 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015854 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15855 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
15856 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15857 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
15858 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015859
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010015860 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
15861 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
15862 the corresponding match text.
15863
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015864 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
15865 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
15866 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
15867 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
15868 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015869
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015870 Example :
15871
15872 # this is a comment and is ignored
15873 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
15874 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
15875 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
15876 | | | `---------- value
15877 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
15878 | `---------------------------- key
15879 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
15880
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015881mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015882 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15883 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015884 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015885 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015886 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015887 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15888 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15889 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15890 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015891 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015892 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015893
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010015894mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname or property ID>)
15895 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
15896 <packettype>.
15897 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
15898 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
15899 from.
15900 Supported string and integers can be found here:
15901 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
15902 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
15903
15904 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
15905 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
15906 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
15907 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
15908
15909 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
15910 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
15911 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
15912 packets only):
15913 17: Session Expiry Interval
15914 33: Receive Maximum
15915 39: Maximum Packet Size
15916 34: Topic Alias Maximum
15917 25: Request Response Information
15918 23: Request Problem Information
15919 21: Authentication Method
15920 22: Authentication Data
15921 18: Will Delay Interval
15922 1: Payload Format Indicator
15923 2: Message Expiry Interval
15924 3: Content Type
15925 8: Response Topic
15926 9: Correlation Data
15927 Not supported yet:
15928 38: User Property
15929
15930 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
15931 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
15932 packets only):
15933 17: Session Expiry Interval
15934 33: Receive Maximum
15935 36: Maximum QoS
15936 37: Retain Available
15937 39: Maximum Packet Size
15938 18: Assigned Client Identifier
15939 34: Topic Alias Maximum
15940 31: Reason String
15941 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
15942 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
15943 42: Shared Subscription Available
15944 19: Server Keep Alive
15945 26: Response Information
15946 28: Server Reference
15947 21: Authentication Method
15948 22: Authentication Data
15949 Not supported yet:
15950 38: User Property
15951
15952 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15953 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
15954 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
15955 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
15956
15957 Example:
15958
15959 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
15960 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
15961 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
15962 if data_in_buffer
15963 # do the same as above
15964 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
15965 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
15966 if data_in_buffer
15967
15968mqtt_is_valid
15969 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
15970
15971 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15972 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
15973 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
15974 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
15975
15976 Example:
15977
15978 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
15979 tcp-request content reject unless req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid
15980
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015981mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015982 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020015983 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
15984 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015985 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015986 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015987 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015988 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15989 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15990 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15991 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015992 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015993 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015994
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010015995nbsrv
15996 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
15997 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
15998 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
15999 map lookup.
16000
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016001neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016002 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
16003 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
16004 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
16005 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016006
16007not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016008 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016009 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016010 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016011 absence of a flag).
16012
16013odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016014 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016015 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
16016
16017or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016018 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016019 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016020 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16021 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016022 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016023 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16024 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16025 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16026 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016027 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016028 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016029
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016030protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
16031 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
16032 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
16033 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
16034 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
16035 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16036 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16037 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16038 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
16039 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
16040 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16041 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
16042
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010016043regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016044 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
16045 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
16046 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
16047 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
16048 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
16049 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
16050 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
16051 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
16052 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016053 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
16054 of characters with other ones.
16055
16056 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
16057 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
16058 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
16059 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
16060 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
16061 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016062
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016063 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016064
16065 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
16066 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
16067 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016068 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016069
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016070 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
16071 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
16072
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016073 # capture groups and backreferences
16074 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020016075 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016076 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
16077
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016078capture-req(<id>)
16079 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
16080 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16081
16082 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016083 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16084 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016085
16086capture-res(<id>)
16087 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
16088 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16089
16090 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016091 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16092 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016093
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020016094rtrim(<chars>)
16095 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
16096 of the input sample.
16097
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016098sdbm([<avalanche>])
16099 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
16100 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16101 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16102 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16103 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16104 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16105 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016106 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
16107 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016108
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016109secure_memcmp(<var>)
16110 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
16111 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
16112 match.
16113
16114 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
16115 performed in constant time.
16116
16117 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
16118 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16119
16120 Example :
16121
16122 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
16123 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
16124 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
16125 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
16126
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016127set-var(<var>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016128 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
16129 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
16130 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016131 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016132 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16133 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016134 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016135 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16136 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016137 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016138 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016139
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016140sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016141 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016142 sample with length of 20 bytes.
16143
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016144sha2([<bits>])
16145 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
16146 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
16147
16148 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
16149 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
16150
16151 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
16152 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16153
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020016154srv_queue
16155 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
16156 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
16157 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
16158 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
16159 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
16160
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016161strcmp(<var>)
16162 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
16163 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
16164 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
16165 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
16166 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
16167 shorter).
16168
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016169 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
16170 strings in constant time.
16171
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016172 Example :
16173
16174 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
16175 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
16176 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
16177
16178
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016179sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016180 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
16181 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016182 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016183 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
16184 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016185 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016186 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16187 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016188 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016189 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16190 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016191 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016192 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016193
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016194table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
16195 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16196 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16197 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
16198 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16199 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16200 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
16201
16202
16203table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
16204 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16205 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16206 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
16207 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16208 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16209 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
16210
16211table_conn_cnt(<table>)
16212 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16213 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016214 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016215 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
16216 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16217
16218table_conn_cur(<table>)
16219 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16220 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16221 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16222 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16223 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
16224
16225table_conn_rate(<table>)
16226 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16227 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16228 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
16229 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16230 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
16231
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016232table_gpt0(<table>)
16233 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16234 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
16235 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16236 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16237 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
16238
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016239table_gpc0(<table>)
16240 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16241 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16242 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16243 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16244 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
16245
16246table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
16247 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16248 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16249 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
16250 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16251 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
16252 sample fetch keyword.
16253
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016254table_gpc1(<table>)
16255 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16256 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16257 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
16258 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16259 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
16260
16261table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
16262 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16263 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16264 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
16265 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16266 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
16267 sample fetch keyword.
16268
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016269table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
16270 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16271 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016272 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016273 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16274 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16275
16276table_http_err_rate(<table>)
16277 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16278 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16279 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
16280 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
16281 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
16282 keyword.
16283
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010016284table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
16285 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16286 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16287 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
16288 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16289 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16290
16291table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
16292 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16293 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16294 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
16295 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
16296 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
16297 keyword.
16298
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016299table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
16300 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16301 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016302 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016303 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16304 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16305
16306table_http_req_rate(<table>)
16307 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16308 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16309 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
16310 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
16311 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
16312 keyword.
16313
16314table_kbytes_in(<table>)
16315 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16316 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016317 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016318 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16319 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16320 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
16321 keyword.
16322
16323table_kbytes_out(<table>)
16324 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16325 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016326 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016327 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16328 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16329 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
16330 keyword.
16331
16332table_server_id(<table>)
16333 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16334 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16335 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
16336 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
16337 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
16338 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
16339
16340table_sess_cnt(<table>)
16341 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16342 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016343 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016344 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
16345 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16346 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
16347 keyword.
16348
16349table_sess_rate(<table>)
16350 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16351 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16352 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
16353 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
16354 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16355 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
16356 keyword.
16357
16358table_trackers(<table>)
16359 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16360 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16361 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16362 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
16363 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
16364 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
16365 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
16366 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
16367 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
16368 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
16369
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016370upper
16371 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
16372 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16373 type. The result is of type string.
16374
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020016375url_dec([<in_form>])
16376 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
16377 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
16378 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
16379 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
16380 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
16381 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020016382
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010016383url_enc([<enc_type>])
16384 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
16385 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
16386 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
16387 optional argument is here for future changes.
16388
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016389ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016390 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016391 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
16392 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
16393 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016394 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16395 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16396 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16397 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016398 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016399 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16400 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016401
16402 Example:
16403 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
16404 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
16405
16406 message Point {
16407 int32 latitude = 1;
16408 int32 longitude = 2;
16409 }
16410
16411 message PPoint {
16412 Point point = 59;
16413 }
16414
16415 message Rectangle {
16416 // One corner of the rectangle.
16417 PPoint lo = 48;
16418 // The other corner of the rectangle.
16419 PPoint hi = 49;
16420 }
16421
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016422 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
16423 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
16424 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016425
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016426 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16427 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016428 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016429 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
16430
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016431 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016432
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016433 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016434
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016435 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
16436 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16437 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016438
16439 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
16440 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
16441 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
16442
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016443 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
16444 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
16445 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016446
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016447
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016448unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010016449 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
16450 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
16451 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
16452 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16453 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
16454 response),
16455 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16456 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
16457 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
16458 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
16459
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016460utime(<format>[,<offset>])
16461 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16462 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
16463 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16464 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16465 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16466 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
16467
16468 Example :
16469
16470 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016471 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016472 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16473
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016474word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16475 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
16476 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
16477 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016478 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016479 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
16480 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
16481
16482 Example :
16483 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
16484 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16485 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
16486 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
16487 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016488 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010016489
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016490wt6([<avalanche>])
16491 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
16492 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16493 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16494 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16495 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16496 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16497 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016498 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
16499 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016500
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016501xor(<value>)
16502 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016503 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016504 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016505 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016506 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016507 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16508 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016509 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016510 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16511 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016512 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016513 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016514
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010016515xxh3([<seed>])
16516 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
16517 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
16518 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
16519 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
16520 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
16521 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
16522 considered as cryptographically secure.
16523
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010016524xxh32([<seed>])
16525 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
16526 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
16527 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
16528 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
16529 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
16530 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
16531 as cryptographically secure.
16532
16533xxh64([<seed>])
16534 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
16535 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
16536 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
16537 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
16538 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
16539 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
16540 as cryptographically secure.
16541
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016542
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200165437.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016544--------------------------------------------
16545
16546A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
16547not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
16548"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
16549The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
16550
16551always_false : boolean
16552 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
16553 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
16554
16555always_true : boolean
16556 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
16557 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
16558
16559avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016560 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016561 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
16562 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
16563 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
16564 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
16565 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
16566 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
16567 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
16568 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
16569 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
16570 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
16571 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
16572 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
16573 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010016574
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016575be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016576 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
16577 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
16578 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
16579 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040016580 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
16581
16582be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
16583 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
16584 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
16585 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
16586 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
16587 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040016588 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
16589 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040016590
16591 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
16592 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
16593 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016594
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016595be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
16596 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16597 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
16598 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016599 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016600 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
16601 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016602
16603 Example :
16604 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
16605 backend dynamic
16606 mode http
16607 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
16608 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016609
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016610bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016611 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
16612 of the string.
16613
16614bool(<bool>) : bool
16615 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
16616 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
16617
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016618connslots([<backend>]) : integer
16619 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016620 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016621 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
16622 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050016623
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016624 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016625 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016626 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
16627
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016628 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
16629 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016630
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016631 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016632 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016633 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016634 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016635 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016636 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016637 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016638
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016639 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
16640 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016641 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016642 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016643
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016644cpu_calls : integer
16645 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
16646 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
16647 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
16648 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
16649 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
16650 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
16651
16652cpu_ns_avg : integer
16653 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
16654 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
16655 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
16656 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
16657 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
16658 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
16659 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
16660 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
16661 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
16662 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
16663 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
16664
16665cpu_ns_tot : integer
16666 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
16667 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
16668 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
16669 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
16670 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
16671 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
16672 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
16673 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
16674 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
16675 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
16676 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
16677 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
16678 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
16679
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016680date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020016681 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016682
16683 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
16684 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
16685 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020016686 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
16687
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016688 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
16689 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
16690 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
16691 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
16692 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
16693
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020016694 Example :
16695
16696 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
16697 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020016698
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016699 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
16700 # millisecond granularity
16701 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
16702
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010016703date_us : integer
16704 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
16705 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
16706 from the same timeval structure.
16707
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020016708distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
16709 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
16710 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
16711 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
16712 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
16713 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
16714 list of supported tokens.
16715
16716distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
16717 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
16718 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
16719 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
16720 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
16721 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
16722 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
16723 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
16724 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
16725 supported tokens.
16726
16727 Example :
16728 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
16729 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
16730 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
16731 # send large files to the big farm
16732 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
16733
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020016734env(<name>) : string
16735 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
16736 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
16737 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
16738 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
16739 certain way.
16740
16741 Examples :
16742 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
16743 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
16744
16745 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
16746 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
16747
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016748fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
16749 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016750 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
16751 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016752 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
16753 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016754 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016755 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
16756 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016757
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020016758fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
16759 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
16760 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
16761 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
16762
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016763fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
16764 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16765 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
16766 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
16767 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
16768 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
16769 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
16770 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
16771 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016772
16773 Example :
16774 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
16775 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
16776 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
16777 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
16778 frontend mail
16779 bind :25
16780 mode tcp
16781 maxconn 100
16782 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
16783 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
16784 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
16785 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016786
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010016787hostname : string
16788 Returns the system hostname.
16789
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016790int(<integer>) : signed integer
16791 Returns a signed integer.
16792
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016793ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
16794 Returns an ipv4.
16795
16796ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
16797 Returns an ipv6.
16798
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016799lat_ns_avg : integer
16800 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
16801 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
16802 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
16803 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
16804 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
16805 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
16806 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
16807 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
16808 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020016809 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
16810 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
16811 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
16812 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
16813 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
16814 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016815
16816lat_ns_tot : integer
16817 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
16818 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
16819 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
16820 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
16821 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
16822 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
16823 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
16824 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
16825 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020016826 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
16827 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
16828 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
16829 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
16830 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016831 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
16832 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
16833 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
16834 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
16835 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
16836 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
16837
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016838meth(<method>) : method
16839 Returns a method.
16840
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016841nbproc : integer
16842 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
16843 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
16844 and debugging purposes.
16845
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016846nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
16847 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
16848 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
16849 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016850 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
16851 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
16852 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016853
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040016854prio_class : integer
16855 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
16856 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
16857 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
16858
16859prio_offset : integer
16860 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
16861 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
16862 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
16863 set-priority-offset".
16864
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016865proc : integer
16866 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
16867 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
16868 debugging purposes.
16869
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016870queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016871 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
16872 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
16873 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016874 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
16875 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
16876 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
16877 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
16878 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
16879
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010016880rand([<range>]) : integer
16881 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
16882 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
16883 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
16884 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
16885 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
16886
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020016887uuid([<version>]) : string
16888 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
16889 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
16890 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
16891
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016892srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16893 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16894 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
16895 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
16896 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
16897 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040016898 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
16899 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
16900
16901srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16902 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
16903 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
16904 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16905 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
16906 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
16907 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
16908 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
16909
16910 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
16911 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016912
16913srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
16914 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
16915 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
16916 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016917 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016918 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
16919 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
16920 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
16921
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020016922srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16923 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
16924 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16925 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
16926 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
16927 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
16928 fetch methods.
16929
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016930srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16931 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16932 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016933 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016934 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
16935 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016936 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016937 overloading servers).
16938
16939 Example :
16940 # Redirect to a separate back
16941 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
16942 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
16943 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
16944
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020016945srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16946 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
16947 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
16948 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
16949
16950srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16951 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
16952 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
16953 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
16954
16955srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16956 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
16957 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
16958 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
16959
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016960stopping : boolean
16961 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
16962 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
16963 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
16964
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016965str(<string>) : string
16966 Returns a string.
16967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016968table_avl([<table>]) : integer
16969 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
16970 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
16971
16972table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16973 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
16974 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
16975 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
16976
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010016977thread : integer
16978 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
16979 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
16980 and debugging purposes.
16981
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016982var(<var-name>) : undefined
16983 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016984 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
16985 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016986 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016987 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16988 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016989 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016990 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16991 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016992 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016993 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016994
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200169957.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016996----------------------------------
16997
16998The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
16999closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
17000methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
17001sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
17002TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017003the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
17004counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020017005"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
17006used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
17007can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
17008Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
17009table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
17010tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
17011currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017012
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010017013bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010017014 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17015 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17016 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
17017
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017018be_id : integer
17019 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017020 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17021 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017022
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017023be_name : string
17024 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017025 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17026 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017027
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010017028be_server_timeout : integer
17029 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
17030 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17031 also the "cur_server_timeout".
17032
17033be_tunnel_timeout : integer
17034 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
17035 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17036 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
17037
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010017038cur_server_timeout : integer
17039 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17040 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
17041 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
17042
17043cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
17044 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17045 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
17046 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
17047
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017048dst : ip
17049 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
17050 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
17051 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
17052 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017053 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
17054 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
17055 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
17056 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
17057 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
17058 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017059
17060dst_conn : integer
17061 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17062 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
17063 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
17064 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
17065 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
17066 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
17067 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
17068 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017069
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017070dst_is_local : boolean
17071 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
17072 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
17073 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
17074 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017075 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017076 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
17077 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
17078 it only once per connection.
17079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017080dst_port : integer
17081 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17082 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
17083 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
17084 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
17085 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
17086 an HTTP header.
17087
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020017088fc_http_major : integer
17089 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17090 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17091 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
17092
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020017093fc_pp_authority : string
17094 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17095 if any.
17096
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010017097fc_pp_unique_id : string
17098 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17099 if any.
17100
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010017101fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
17102 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
17103 header.
17104
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020017105fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
17106 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
17107 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
17108 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
17109 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17110 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17111 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17112
17113fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
17114 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
17115 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
17116 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
17117 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17118 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17119 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17120
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017121fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017122 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17123 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17124 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17125 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17126
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017127fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017128 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17129 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17130 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17131 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17132
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017133fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017134 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
17135 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17136 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17137 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17138
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017139fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017140 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
17141 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17142 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17143 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17144
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017145fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017146 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
17147 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17148 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17149 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17150
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017151fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017152 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
17153 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17154 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17155 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17156
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020017157fe_defbe : string
17158 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
17159 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
17160
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017161fe_id : integer
17162 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010017163 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017164 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17165
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017166fe_name : string
17167 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
17168 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
17169 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17170
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010017171fe_client_timeout : integer
17172 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
17173 current frontend.
17174
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017175sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017176sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17177sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17178sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017179 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
17180 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17181 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
17182
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017183sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017184sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17185sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17186sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017187 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
17188 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17189 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
17190
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017191sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017192sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17193sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17194sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017195 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17196 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017197 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17198 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17199 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017200
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017201 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017202 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17203 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017204 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17205 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
17206 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017207 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17208 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17209
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017210sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17211sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17212sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17213sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17214 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17215 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
17216 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17217 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17218 when a first ACL was verified.
17219
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017220sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017221sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17222sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17223sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017224 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017225 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
17226
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017227sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017228sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17229sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17230sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017231 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17232 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
17233 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
17234
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017235sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017236sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17237sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17238sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017239 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
17240 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
17241 See also src_conn_rate.
17242
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017243sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017244sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17245sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17246sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017247 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017248 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017249
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017250sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17251sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17252sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17253sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17254 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
17255 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
17256
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017257sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17258sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17259sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17260sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17261 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17262 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
17263
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017264sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017265sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17266sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17267sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017268 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
17269 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17270 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017271 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17272 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17273 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017274
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017275sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17276sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17277sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17278sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17279 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
17280 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17281 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17282 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17283 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17284 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17285
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017286sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017287sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17288sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17289sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017290 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017291 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
17292 See also src_http_err_cnt.
17293
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017294sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017295sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17296sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17297sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017298 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
17299 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
17300 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
17301 src_http_err_rate.
17302
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017303sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17304sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17305sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17306sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17307 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
17308 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
17309 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
17310
17311sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17312sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17313sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17314sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17315 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
17316 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
17317 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
17318 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
17319
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017320sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017321sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17322sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17323sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017324 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017325 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
17326 src_http_req_cnt.
17327
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017328sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017329sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17330sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17331sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017332 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
17333 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
17334 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
17335 src_http_req_rate.
17336
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017337sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017338sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17339sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17340sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017341 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017342 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
17343 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
17344 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
17345 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017346
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017347 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017348 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17349 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017350 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17351
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017352sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17353sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17354sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17355sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17356 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
17357 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
17358 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
17359 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
17360 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
17361
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017362sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017363sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
17364sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
17365sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017366 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
17367 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
17368 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017369
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017370sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017371sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
17372sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
17373sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017374 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
17375 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
17376 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017377
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017378sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017379sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17380sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17381sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017382 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017383 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
17384 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
17385 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017386 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017387 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
17388
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017389sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017390sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17391sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17392sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017393 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
17394 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
17395 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
17396 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
17397 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017398 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017399
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017400sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017401sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
17402sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
17403sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020017404 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
17405 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
17406 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
17407
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017408sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017409sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17410sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17411sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017412 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17413 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017414 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017415 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
17416 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017417 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
17418 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
17419 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017420
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017421so_id : integer
17422 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
17423 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
17424 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017425
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010017426so_name : string
17427 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
17428 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
17429 strings instead of integers.
17430
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017431src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017432 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017433 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
17434 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
17435 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017436 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
17437 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
17438 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017439 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
17440 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
17441 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
17442 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
17443 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
17444 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
17445 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017446
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017447 Example:
17448 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
17449 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
17450
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017451src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17452 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
17453 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
17454 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017455 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017456
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017457src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17458 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
17459 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017460 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017461 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017462
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017463src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17464 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17465 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17466 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
17467 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
17468 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
17469 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017470
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017471 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017472 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17473 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
17474 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
17475 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017476 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017477 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17478 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17479
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017480src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17481 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17482 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17483 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
17484 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
17485 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
17486 was verified.
17487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017488src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017489 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017490 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017491 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017492 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017493
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017494src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017495 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017496 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
17497 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017498 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017499
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017500src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17501 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
17502 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17503 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017504 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017505
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017506src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017507 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017508 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017509 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017510 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017511
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017512src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17513 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
17514 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
17515 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
17516 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
17517
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017518src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17519 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17520 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
17521 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
17522 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
17523
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017524src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017525 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017526 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017527 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
17528 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017529 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17530 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17531 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017532
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017533src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17534 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
17535 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
17536 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
17537 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17538 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17539 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17540 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017542src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017543 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017544 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017545 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017546 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017547 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017548
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017549src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17550 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
17551 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17552 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
17553 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017554 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017555
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017556src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17557 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
17558 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
17559 the designated stick-table. This includes the both repsonse errors and 5xx
17560 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
17561 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
17562
17563src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17564 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
17565 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17566 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
17567 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
17568 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
17569 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
17570
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017571src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017572 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017573 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
17574 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017575 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017576
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017577src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17578 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
17579 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
17580 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017581 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017582 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017583
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017584src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17585 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17586 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17587 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017588 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017589 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
17590 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017591
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017592 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017593 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017594 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017595 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017596
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017597src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17598 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17599 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17600 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
17601 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
17602 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
17603 connection when a first ACL was verified.
17604
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017605src_is_local : boolean
17606 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
17607 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
17608 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
17609 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017610 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017611 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
17612 once per connection.
17613
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017614src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017615 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
17616 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
17617 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
17618 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
17619 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017620
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017621src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017622 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
17623 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17624 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
17625 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
17626 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017627
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017628src_port : integer
17629 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
17630 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
17631 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
17632 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017634src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017635 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017636 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17637 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
17638 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017639 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017640
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017641src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17642 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
17643 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17644 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
17645 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017646 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017648src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17649 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
17650 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
17651 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
17652 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
17653 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
17654 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
17655 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
17656 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017657
17658 Example :
17659 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
17660 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
17661 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
17662 listen ssh
17663 bind :22
17664 mode tcp
17665 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017666 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017667 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017668 server local 127.0.0.1:22
17669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017670srv_id : integer
17671 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
17672 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017673 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020017674
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080017675srv_name : string
17676 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
17677 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017678 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080017679
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200176807.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017681----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020017682
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017683The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
17684closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
17685when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
17686usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017687future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020017688
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001768951d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
17690 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
17691 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
17692 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
17693 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
17694 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
17695
17696 Example :
17697 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
17698 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
17699 # the request.
17700 frontend http-in
17701 bind *:8081
17702 default_backend servers
17703 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
17704 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
17705
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017706ssl_bc : boolean
17707 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
17708 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017709 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17710 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017711
17712ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
17713 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017714 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
17715 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017716
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017717ssl_bc_alpn : string
17718 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
17719 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020017720 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017721 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
17722 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
17723 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
17724 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
17725 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017726 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
17727 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017728
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017729ssl_bc_cipher : string
17730 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017731 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17732 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017733
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017734ssl_bc_client_random : binary
17735 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
17736 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17737 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017738 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017739
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010017740ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
17741 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17742 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017743 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
17744 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010017745
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017746ssl_bc_npn : string
17747 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
17748 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020017749 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017750 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
17751 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
17752 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
17753 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017754 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
17755 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017756
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017757ssl_bc_protocol : string
17758 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017759 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17760 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017761
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017762ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017763 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017764 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017765 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
17766 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017767
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017768ssl_bc_server_random : binary
17769 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
17770 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17771 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017772 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017773
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017774ssl_bc_session_id : binary
17775 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
17776 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017777 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
17778 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017779
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017780ssl_bc_session_key : binary
17781 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
17782 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
17783 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017784 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017785
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017786ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
17787 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017788 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
17789 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017790
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017791ssl_c_ca_err : integer
17792 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17793 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
17794 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
17795 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
17796 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020017797
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017798ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
17799 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17800 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
17801 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
17802 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017803
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010017804ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020017805 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
17806 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17807 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050017808 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020017809 does not support resumed sessions.
17810
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010017811ssl_c_der : binary
17812 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
17813 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17814 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17815
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017816ssl_c_err : integer
17817 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17818 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
17819 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
17820 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
17821 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017822
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017823ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017824 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17825 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17826 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17827 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17828 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17829 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17830 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17831 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017832 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17833 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17834 LDAP v3.
17835 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17836 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017837
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017838ssl_c_key_alg : string
17839 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17840 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17841 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017842
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017843ssl_c_notafter : string
17844 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
17845 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17846 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020017847
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017848ssl_c_notbefore : string
17849 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
17850 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17851 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010017852
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017853ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017854 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17855 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17856 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17857 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17858 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17859 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17860 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17861 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017862 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17863 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17864 LDAP v3.
17865 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17866 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010017867
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017868ssl_c_serial : binary
17869 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
17870 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17871 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017872
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017873ssl_c_sha1 : binary
17874 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
17875 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
17876 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020017877 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
17878 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
17879
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017880 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020017881 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017882
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017883ssl_c_sig_alg : string
17884 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17885 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17886 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017887
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017888ssl_c_used : boolean
17889 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
17890 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017891
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017892ssl_c_verify : integer
17893 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
17894 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
17895 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
17896 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017897
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017898ssl_c_version : integer
17899 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
17900 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017901
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010017902ssl_f_der : binary
17903 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
17904 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17905 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17906
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017907ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017908 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17909 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17910 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17911 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017912 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017913 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17914 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17915 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017916 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17917 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17918 LDAP v3.
17919 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17920 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017921
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017922ssl_f_key_alg : string
17923 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17924 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
17925 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017926
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017927ssl_f_notafter : string
17928 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
17929 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17930 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017931
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017932ssl_f_notbefore : string
17933 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
17934 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17935 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017936
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017937ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017938 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17939 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17940 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17941 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17942 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17943 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17944 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17945 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017946 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17947 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17948 LDAP v3.
17949 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17950 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017951
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017952ssl_f_serial : binary
17953 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
17954 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17955 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017956
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020017957ssl_f_sha1 : binary
17958 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
17959 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
17960 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
17961
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017962ssl_f_sig_alg : string
17963 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17964 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17965 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017966
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017967ssl_f_version : integer
17968 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
17969 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
17970
17971ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017972 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
17973 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
17974 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
17975
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017976 Example :
17977 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
17978 listen http-https
17979 bind :80
17980 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
17981 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
17982
17983ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
17984 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
17985 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
17986
17987ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017988 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017989 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
17990 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
17991 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
17992 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
17993 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
17994 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
17995 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
17996 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
17997
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017998ssl_fc_cipher : string
17999 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
18000 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020018001
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018002ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
18003 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
18004 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018005 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018006
18007ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
18008 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
18009 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018010 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018011
18012ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
18013 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
18014 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
18015 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018016 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020018017 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018018
18019ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
18020 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
18021 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018022 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018023
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018024ssl_fc_client_random : binary
18025 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18026 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18027 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18028
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018029ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
18030 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18031 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18032 transport layer.
18033 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18034 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18035 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18036 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18037
18038ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18039 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18040 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18041 transport layer.
18042 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18043 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18044 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18045 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18046
18047ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
18048 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18049 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18050 transport layer.
18051 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18052 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18053 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18054 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18055
18056ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
18057 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18058 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18059 transport layer.
18060 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18061 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18062 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18063 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18064
18065ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
18066 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18067 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18068 transport layer.
18069 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18070 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18071 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18072 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18073
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018074ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018075 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
18076 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010018077 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
18078 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
18079 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
18080 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018081
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020018082ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
18083 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
18084 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
18085 wait until the handshake happened.
18086
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018087ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
18088 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018089 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
18090 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018091 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018092 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018093
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020018094ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018095 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010018096 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
18097 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018098
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018099ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018100 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018101 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
18102 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
18103 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
18104 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
18105 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
18106 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
18107 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020018108
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018109ssl_fc_protocol : string
18110 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
18111 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018112
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018113ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018114 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018115 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
18116 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018117
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018118ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18119 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18120 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18121 transport layer.
18122 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18123 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18124 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18125 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18126
18127ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
18128 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18129 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18130 transport layer.
18131 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18132 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18133 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18134 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18135
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018136ssl_fc_server_random : binary
18137 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18138 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18139 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18140
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018141ssl_fc_session_id : binary
18142 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
18143 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
18144 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
18145 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018146
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018147ssl_fc_session_key : binary
18148 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
18149 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18150 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
18151 BoringSSL.
18152
18153
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018154ssl_fc_sni : string
18155 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
18156 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
18157 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
18158 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
18159 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
18160
18161 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
18162 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
18163 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018164 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020018165 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018166
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018167 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018168 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
18169 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020018170
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018171ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
18172 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
18173 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018174
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018175ssl_s_der : binary
18176 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
18177 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18178 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18179
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018180ssl_s_chain_der : binary
18181 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
18182 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18183 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018184 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018185 does not support resumed sessions.
18186
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018187ssl_s_key_alg : string
18188 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18189 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
18190 SSL/TLS transport layer.
18191
18192ssl_s_notafter : string
18193 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
18194 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18195 transport layer.
18196
18197ssl_s_notbefore : string
18198 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
18199 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18200 transport layer.
18201
18202ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18203 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18204 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18205 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18206 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18207 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18208 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018209 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18210 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018211 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18212 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18213 LDAP v3.
18214 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18215 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18216
18217ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18218 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18219 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18220 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18221 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18222 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18223 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018224 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18225 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018226 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18227 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18228 LDAP v3.
18229 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18230 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18231
18232ssl_s_serial : binary
18233 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
18234 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18235 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18236
18237ssl_s_sha1 : binary
18238 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
18239 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18240 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18241
18242ssl_s_sig_alg : string
18243 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18244 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18245 layer.
18246
18247ssl_s_version : integer
18248 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
18249 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018250
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200182517.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018252------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018253
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018254Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
18255sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
18256only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
18257For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
18258be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
18259can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
18260sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
18261for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
18262content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018263
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018264payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018265 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018266 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
18267 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018268
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018269payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
18270 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018271 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018272 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018273
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018274req.len : integer
18275req_len : integer (deprecated)
18276 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18277 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18278 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18279 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18280 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
18281 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
18282 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
18283 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018284
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018285req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18286 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018287 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
18288 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
18289 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
18290 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018291
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018292 ACL alternatives :
18293 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018294
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018295req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
18296 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
18297 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
18298 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
18299 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018300
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018301 ACL alternatives :
18302 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018304 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018305
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018306req.proto_http : boolean
18307req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
18308 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
18309 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
18310 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
18311 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
18312 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
18313 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
18314 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018315
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018316 Example:
18317 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
18318 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18319 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018320 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018321
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018322req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
18323rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18324 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
18325 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
18326 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
18327 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
18328 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
18329 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
18330 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018331
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018332 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
18333 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
18334 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
18335 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
18336 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
18337 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018338
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018339 ACL derivatives :
18340 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018341
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018342 Example :
18343 listen tse-farm
18344 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
18345 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
18346 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18347 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
18348 # apply RDP cookie persistence
18349 persist rdp-cookie
18350 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
18351 # This is only useful makes sense if
18352 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
18353 stick-table type string size 204800
18354 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
18355 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
18356 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018357
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018358 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
18359 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018360
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018361req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
18362rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
18363 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
18364 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
18365 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
18366 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018367
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018368 ACL derivatives :
18369 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018370
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018371req.ssl_alpn : string
18372 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
18373 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
18374 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
18375 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
18376 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
18377 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020018378 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018379
18380 Examples :
18381 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
18382 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18383 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020018384 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018385 default_backend bk_default
18386
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020018387req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
18388 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
18389 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020018390 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
18391 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
18392 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
18393 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
18394 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020018395
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018396req.ssl_hello_type : integer
18397req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
18398 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
18399 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
18400 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
18401 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
18402 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
18403 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
18404 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018405
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018406req.ssl_sni : string
18407req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
18408 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
18409 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
18410 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
18411 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
18412 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020018413 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
18414 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
18415 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
18416 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
18417 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
18418 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
18419 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
18420 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
18421 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018423 ACL derivatives :
18424 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018425
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018426 Examples :
18427 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
18428 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18429 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
18430 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
18431 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018432
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053018433req.ssl_st_ext : integer
18434 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
18435 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
18436 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
18437 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
18438 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
18439 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
18440 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
18441 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
18442 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
18443
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018444req.ssl_ver : integer
18445req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
18446 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
18447 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
18448 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
18449 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
18450 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
18451 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
18452 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018453 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018454 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018455
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018456 ACL derivatives :
18457 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018458
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020018459res.len : integer
18460 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18461 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18462 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18463 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18464 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
18465 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
18466 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018467 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020018468
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018469res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18470 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018471 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018472 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018473 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018474 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018475
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018476res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
18477 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
18478 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
18479 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018480 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
18481 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018483 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018484
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020018485res.ssl_hello_type : integer
18486rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
18487 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
18488 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
18489 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
18490 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
18491 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
18492 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
18493 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
18494
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018495wait_end : boolean
18496 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
18497 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018498 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018499 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
18500 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018501 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018502 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
18503 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018504
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018505 Examples :
18506 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
18507 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
18508 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018509
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018510 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
18511 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18512 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
18513 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
18514 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
18515 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
18516 tcp-request content reject
18517
18518
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200185197.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018520--------------------------------------
18521
18522It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
18523This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
18524data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
18525its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
18526HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
18527content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
18528to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
18529more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
18530response are indexed.
18531
18532base : string
18533 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
18534 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
18535 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
18536 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
18537 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
18538 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
18539 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
18540 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
18541
18542 ACL derivatives :
18543 base : exact string match
18544 base_beg : prefix match
18545 base_dir : subdir match
18546 base_dom : domain match
18547 base_end : suffix match
18548 base_len : length match
18549 base_reg : regex match
18550 base_sub : substring match
18551
18552base32 : integer
18553 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
18554 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
18555 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018556 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
18557 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
18558 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018559
18560base32+src : binary
18561 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
18562 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
18563 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
18564 per-URL counters.
18565
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010018566baseq : string
18567 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
18568 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
18569 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
18570 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
18571
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010018572capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
18573 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
18574 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
18575 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
18576
18577capture.req.method : string
18578 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
18579 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
18580 because it's allocated.
18581
18582capture.req.uri : string
18583 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
18584 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
18585 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
18586 allocated.
18587
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020018588capture.req.ver : string
18589 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
18590 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
18591 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
18592
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010018593capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
18594 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
18595 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
18596 The first entry is an index of 0.
18597 See also: "capture response header"
18598
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020018599capture.res.ver : string
18600 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
18601 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
18602 persistent flag.
18603
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018604req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018605 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
18606 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
18607 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018608
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020018609req.body_param([<name>) : string
18610 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
18611 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
18612 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
18613 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
18614 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
18615 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
18616 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
18617 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
18618 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
18619 given.
18620
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018621req.body_len : integer
18622 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
18623 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018624 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
18625 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018626
18627req.body_size : integer
18628 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018629 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
18630 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018631
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018632req.cook([<name>]) : string
18633cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18634 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18635 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
18636 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
18637 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
18638 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
18639 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
18640 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
18641 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
18642
18643 ACL derivatives :
18644 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
18645 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
18646 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
18647 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
18648 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
18649 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
18650 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
18651 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018653req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18654cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18655 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
18656 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018657
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018658req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
18659cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18660 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18661 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
18662 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
18663 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018665cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18666 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18667 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
18668 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
18669 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020018670 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018671 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
18672 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
18673 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
18674 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018675
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018676hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18677 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
18678 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
18679 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
18680 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018681 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018682
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018683req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018684 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
18685 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
18686 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
18687 with headers such as User-Agent.
18688
18689 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
18690 found.
18691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018692 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18693 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18694 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018695 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018696
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018697req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18698 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
18699 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018700 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
18701 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018702
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018703req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018704 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
18705 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
18706 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
18707 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
18708 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
18709 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
18710 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
18711
18712 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
18713 found.
18714
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018715 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18716 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18717 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018718 with -1 being the last one.
18719
18720 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
18721 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018722
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018723 ACL derivatives :
18724 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
18725 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
18726 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
18727 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
18728 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
18729 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
18730 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
18731 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
18732
18733req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18734hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
18735 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
18736 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018737 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
18738 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
18739 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
18740
18741 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
18742 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
18743 which contain more than one of certain headers.
18744
18745 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018746
18747req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
18748hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
18749 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
18750 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
18751 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018752 of every header is checked.
18753
18754 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
18755
18756 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018757
18758req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
18759hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
18760 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
18761 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
18762 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018763
18764 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
18765
18766 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018767
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010018768req.hdrs : string
18769 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
18770 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
18771 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
18772 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
18773
18774req.hdrs_bin : binary
18775 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
18776 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
18777 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
18778 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
18779 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
18780 names and values (length of 0 for both).
18781
18782 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010018783
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010018784 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
18785 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010018786
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018787http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
18788 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
18789 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
18790 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
18791 basic auth is supported.
18792
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010018793http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
18794 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
18795 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
18796 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
18797 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018798 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
18799 basic auth is supported.
18800
18801 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010018802 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
18803 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
18804 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
18805 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018806
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018807http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018808 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
18809 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
18810 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018811
18812http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018813 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
18814 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
18815 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018816
18817http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018818 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
18819 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
18820 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018822http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020018823 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
18824 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018825 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
18826 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020018827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018828method : integer + string
18829 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
18830 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
18831 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
18832 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
18833 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
18834 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
18835 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018836
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018837 ACL derivatives :
18838 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018840 Example :
18841 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
18842 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
18843 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018844
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018845path : string
18846 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
18847 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
18848 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
18849 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
18850 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018851 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018852 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018853
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018854 ACL derivatives :
18855 path : exact string match
18856 path_beg : prefix match
18857 path_dir : subdir match
18858 path_dom : domain match
18859 path_end : suffix match
18860 path_len : length match
18861 path_reg : regex match
18862 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018863
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020018864pathq : string
18865 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
18866 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
18867 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
18868 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
18869 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
18870 result in both cases.
18871
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010018872query : string
18873 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
18874 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
18875 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
18876 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018877 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010018878 which stops before the question mark.
18879
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018880req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
18881 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
18882 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
18883 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
18884 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
18885
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018886req.ver : string
18887req_ver : string (deprecated)
18888 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
18889 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
18890 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018891
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018892 ACL derivatives :
18893 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018894
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018895res.body : binary
18896 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
18897 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018898 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
18899
18900 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018901
18902res.body_len : integer
18903 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
18904 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018905 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
18906
18907 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018908
18909res.body_size : integer
18910 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
18911 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
18912 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
18913 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018914 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
18915
18916 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018917
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010018918res.cache_hit : boolean
18919 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
18920 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
18921
18922res.cache_name : string
18923 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
18924 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
18925 empty string.
18926
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018927res.comp : boolean
18928 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
18929 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
18930 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018931
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018932res.comp_algo : string
18933 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
18934 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
18935 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018936
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018937res.cook([<name>]) : string
18938scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18939 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18940 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018941 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
18942
18943 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020018944
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018945 ACL derivatives :
18946 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020018947
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018948res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18949scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18950 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
18951 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018952 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
18953
18954 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018955
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018956res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
18957scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18958 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18959 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018960 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
18961
18962 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018963
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018964res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018965 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
18966 on the headers within an HTTP response.
18967
18968 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
18969 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
18970
18971 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
18972
18973 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018974
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018975res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018976 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
18977 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
18978
18979 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
18980 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
18981
18982 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018983
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018984res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18985shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018986 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
18987 on the headers within an HTTP response.
18988
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050018989 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018990 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
18991
18992 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018993
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018994 ACL derivatives :
18995 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
18996 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
18997 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
18998 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
18999 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19000 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19001 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19002 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19003
19004res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19005shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019006 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19007 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19008
19009 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019010 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019011
19012 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019013
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019014res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19015shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019016 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
19017 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19018
19019 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19020
19021 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019022
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019023res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19024 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19025 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19026 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019027 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19028
19029 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019030
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019031res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19032shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019033 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
19034 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19035
19036 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19037
19038 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019039
19040res.hdrs : string
19041 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
19042 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19043 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019044 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19045
19046 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019047
19048res.hdrs_bin : binary
19049 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19050 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
19051 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
19052 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
19053 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
19054 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
19055 (length of 0 for both).
19056
19057 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
19058
19059 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19060 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019062res.ver : string
19063resp_ver : string (deprecated)
19064 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019065 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
19066
19067 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019068
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019069 ACL derivatives :
19070 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019071
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019072set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19073 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19074 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019075 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019076 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019077
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019078 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
19079 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019080
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019081status : integer
19082 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
19083 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019084 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
19085
19086 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019087
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020019088unique-id : string
19089 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
19090 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
19091 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
19092 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
19093 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
19094 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
19095
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019096url : string
19097 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
19098 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
19099 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
19100 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
19101 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
19102 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
19103 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019104
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019105 ACL derivatives :
19106 url : exact string match
19107 url_beg : prefix match
19108 url_dir : subdir match
19109 url_dom : domain match
19110 url_end : suffix match
19111 url_len : length match
19112 url_reg : regex match
19113 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019115url_ip : ip
19116 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
19117 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
19118 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
19119 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
19120 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
19121 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19122 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019123
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019124url_port : integer
19125 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
19126 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
19127 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19128 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019129
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019130urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
19131url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019132 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
19133 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019134 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
19135 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
19136 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
19137 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019138 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
19139 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019140 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
19141 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019142
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019143 ACL derivatives :
19144 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
19145 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
19146 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
19147 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
19148 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
19149 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
19150 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
19151 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019152
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019153
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019154 Example :
19155 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
19156 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
19157 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
19158 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019159
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019160urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019161 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
19162 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
19163 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020019164
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020019165url32 : integer
19166 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
19167 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
19168 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
19169 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
19170 is an unsigned integer.
19171
19172url32+src : binary
19173 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
19174 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
19175 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
19176
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020019177
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200191787.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019179---------------------------------------
19180
19181This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
19182used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
19183purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
19184There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
19185or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
19186any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
19187for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
19188
19189internal.htx.data : integer
19190 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
19191 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19192
19193internal.htx.free : integer
19194 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
19195 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19196
19197internal.htx.free_data : integer
19198 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
19199 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19200
19201internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010019202 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
19203 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
19204 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019205
19206internal.htx.nbblks : integer
19207 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
19208 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19209
19210internal.htx.size : integer
19211 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
19212 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19213
19214internal.htx.used : integer
19215 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
19216 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19217 direction.
19218
19219internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
19220 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19221 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
19222 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
19223 of the special value :
19224 * head : The oldest inserted block
19225 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019226 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019227
19228internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
19229 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19230 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
19231 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
19232 integer or one of the special value :
19233 * head : The oldest inserted block
19234 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019235 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019236
19237internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
19238 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19239 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
19240 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19241 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19242
19243 * head : The oldest inserted block
19244 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019245 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019246
19247internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
19248 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
19249 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
19250 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19251 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19252
19253 * head : The oldest inserted block
19254 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019255 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019256
19257internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
19258 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
19259 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
19260 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19261 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19262
19263 * head : The oldest inserted block
19264 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019265 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019266
19267internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
19268 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
19269 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
19270 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19271 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19272
19273 * head : The oldest inserted block
19274 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019275 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019276
19277internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
19278 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
19279 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
19280 it returns false.
19281
19282
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200192837.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019284---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019285
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019286Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
19287every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020019288order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019289
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019290ACL name Equivalent to Usage
19291---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019292FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020019293HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019294HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
19295HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019296HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
19297HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
19298HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
19299HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
19300LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019301METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020019302METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019303METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
19304METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
19305METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
19306METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020019307METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019308METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020019309RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019310REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019311TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019312WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
19313---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019314
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010019315
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200193168. Logging
19317----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010019318
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019319One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
19320provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
19321very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
19322provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
19323state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019324to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019325headers.
19326
19327In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
19328about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
19329send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
19330
19331 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
19332 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
19333 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
19334 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
19335 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019336 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060019337 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019338
19339The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
19340allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
19341as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
19342while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
19343real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
19344delay.
19345
19346
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200193478.1. Log levels
19348---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019349
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019350TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019351source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019352HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
19353in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
19354track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
19355syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
19356about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019357
19358
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200193598.2. Log formats
19360----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019361
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019362HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019363and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
19364slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
19365options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019366
19367 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
19368 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
19369 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
19370 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
19371 extents.
19372
19373 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
19374 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
19375 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
19376 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
19377 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
19378
19379 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
19380 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
19381 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
19382 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
19383 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
19384
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020019385 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
19386 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
19387 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
19388 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
19389
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019390 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
19391
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019392Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
19393specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
19394field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
19395servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
19396always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
19397identifier.
19398
19399Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
19400 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
19401 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
19402 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
19403 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
19404
19405
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200194068.2.1. Default log format
19407-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019408
19409This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
19410as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
19411format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
19412
19413 Example :
19414 listen www
19415 mode http
19416 log global
19417 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19418
19419 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
19420 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
19421 (www/HTTP)
19422
19423 Field Format Extract from the example above
19424 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
19425 2 'Connect from' Connect from
19426 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
19427 4 'to' to
19428 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
19429 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
19430
19431Detailed fields description :
19432 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
19433 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
19434 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
19435 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
19436 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19437 and processed the connection.
19438 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
19439
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019440In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
19441"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
19442connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
19443
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019444It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
19445will eventually disappear.
19446
19447
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200194488.2.2. TCP log format
19449---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019450
19451The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
19452is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
19453information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
19454counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
19455emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
19456environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
19457the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
19458sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019459specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
19460not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
19461fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
19462marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019463
19464 Example :
19465 frontend fnt
19466 mode tcp
19467 option tcplog
19468 log global
19469 default_backend bck
19470
19471 backend bck
19472 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19473
19474 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
19475 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
19476 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
19477
19478 Field Format Extract from the example above
19479 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
19480 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
19481 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
19482 4 frontend_name fnt
19483 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
19484 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
19485 7 bytes_read* 212
19486 8 termination_state --
19487 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
19488 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
19489
19490Detailed fields description :
19491 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019492 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
19493 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
19494 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019495 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019496 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019497 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019498
19499 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019500 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
19501 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
19502 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019503
19504 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
19505 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
19506 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019507 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
19508 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
19509 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
19510 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019511
19512 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19513 and processed the connection.
19514
19515 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
19516 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
19517 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
19518 applications.
19519
19520 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
19521 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
19522 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
19523 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
19524 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
19525
19526 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
19527 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
19528 See "Timers" below for more details.
19529
19530 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
19531 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
19532 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
19533 "Timers" below for more details.
19534
19535 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019536 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019537 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
19538 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
19539 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
19540 details.
19541
19542 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
19543 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
19544 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
19545 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
19546 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
19547
19548 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
19549 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
19550 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
19551 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
19552 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
19553 for more details.
19554
19555 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019556 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019557 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
19558 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
19559 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019560 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019561
19562 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
19563 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
19564 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
19565 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
19566 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
19567 caused by a denial of service attack.
19568
19569 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
19570 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
19571 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
19572 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
19573 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
19574 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
19575 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
19576 denial of service attack.
19577
19578 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
19579 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
19580 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
19581 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
19582 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
19583 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
19584 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
19585 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
19586 be processed than on other servers.
19587
19588 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
19589 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
19590 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
19591 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
19592 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
19593 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
19594 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
19595 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
19596 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
19597 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
19598 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
19599 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
19600 should not be attributed to the logged server.
19601
19602 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19603 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
19604 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
19605 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
19606 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
19607 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019608 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019609 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
19610
19611 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19612 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
19613 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
19614 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
19615 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
19616 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019617 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019618 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
19619 occurs.
19620
19621
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200196228.2.3. HTTP log format
19623----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019624
19625The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
19626is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
19627the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
19628are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
19629emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
19630generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
19631"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
19632which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019633frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
19634is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019635
19636Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
19637slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
19638with a star ('*') after the field name below.
19639
19640 Example :
19641 frontend http-in
19642 mode http
19643 option httplog
19644 log global
19645 default_backend bck
19646
19647 backend static
19648 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19649
19650 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
19651 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
19652 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019653 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019654
19655 Field Format Extract from the example above
19656 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
19657 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019658 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019659 4 frontend_name http-in
19660 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019661 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019662 7 status_code 200
19663 8 bytes_read* 2750
19664 9 captured_request_cookie -
19665 10 captured_response_cookie -
19666 11 termination_state ----
19667 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
19668 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
19669 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
19670 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
19671 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019672
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019673Detailed fields description :
19674 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019675 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
19676 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
19677 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019678 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019679 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019680 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019681
19682 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019683 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
19684 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
19685 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019686
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019687 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
19688 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019689
19690 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19691 and processed the connection.
19692
19693 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
19694 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
19695 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
19696
19697 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
19698 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
19699 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
19700 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
19701 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
19702 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
19703
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019704 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
19705 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
19706 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019707 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019708 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
19709 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019710 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
19711 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019712
19713 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
19714 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019715 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019716
19717 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
19718 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019719 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
19720 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019721
19722 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
19723 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
19724 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
19725 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
19726 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019727 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
19728 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019729
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019730 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
19731 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
19732 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
19733 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
19734 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
19735 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
19736 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019737 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019738
19739 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
19740 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
19741 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
19742
19743 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
19744 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019745 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019746 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
19747 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
19748 overflowing.
19749
19750 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
19751 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
19752 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
19753 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
19754 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
19755 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
19756 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
19757 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
19758
19759 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
19760 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
19761 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
19762 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
19763 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
19764 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
19765 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
19766 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
19767
19768 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
19769 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
19770 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
19771 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
19772 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
19773 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
19774 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
19775
19776 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019777 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019778 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
19779 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
19780 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019781 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019782 system.
19783
19784 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
19785 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
19786 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
19787 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
19788 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
19789 caused by a denial of service attack.
19790
19791 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
19792 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
19793 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
19794 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
19795 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
19796 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
19797 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
19798 denial of service attack.
19799
19800 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
19801 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
19802 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
19803 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
19804 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
19805 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
19806 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
19807 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
19808 processed than on other servers.
19809
19810 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
19811 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
19812 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
19813 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
19814 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
19815 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
19816 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
19817 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
19818 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
19819 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
19820 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
19821 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
19822 should not be attributed to the logged server.
19823
19824 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19825 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
19826 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
19827 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
19828 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
19829 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019830 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019831 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
19832
19833 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19834 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
19835 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
19836 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
19837 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
19838 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019839 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019840 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
19841 occurs.
19842
19843 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
19844 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
19845 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
19846 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
19847 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
19848 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
19849 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
19850 cookies" below for more details.
19851
19852 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
19853 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
19854 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
19855 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
19856 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
19857 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
19858 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
19859 and cookies" below for more details.
19860
19861 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
19862 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
19863 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
19864 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
19865 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
19866 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
19867 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
19868 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
19869
19870
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200198718.2.4. Custom log format
19872------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019873
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019874The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019875mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019876
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019877HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019878Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
19879separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
19880prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
19881
19882Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
19883variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019884("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019885
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010019886If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020019887as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010019888less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
19889the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
19890
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020019891Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
19892"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
19893delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
19894preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019895
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019896Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
19897'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
19898https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
19899such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
19900
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019901Flags are :
19902 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019903 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019904 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
19905 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019906
19907 Example:
19908
19909 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
19910 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
19911
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019912 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
19913
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019914At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
19915
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019916 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
19917 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019918
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019919the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019920
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019921 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
19922 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
19923 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019924
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019925and the default TCP format is defined this way :
19926
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019927 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
19928 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019929
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019930Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
19931
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019932 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019933 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019934 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
19935 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
19936 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019937 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
19938 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
19939 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019940 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000019941 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000019942 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000019943 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000019944 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000019945 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
19946 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010019947 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020019948 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019949 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019950 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019951 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020019952 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080019953 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019954 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
19955 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
19956 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
19957 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
19958 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019959 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019960 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019961 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019962 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019963 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019964 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
19965 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019966 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
19967 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
19968 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019969 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019970 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
19971 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019972 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019973 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
19974 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
19975 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020019976 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020019977 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020019978 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
19979 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
19980 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
19981 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020019982 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019983 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019984 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019985 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010019986 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019987 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019988 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
19989 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
19990 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019991 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019992 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
19993 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019994 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019995 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
19996 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020019997 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019998 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019999 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020000 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020001
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020002 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020003
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020004
200058.2.5. Error log format
20006-----------------------
20007
20008When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
20009protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
20010By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
20011"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020012will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020013logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
20014
20015The format looks like this :
20016
20017 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
20018 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
20019 Connection error during SSL handshake
20020
20021 Field Format Extract from the example above
20022 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
20023 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
20024 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
20025 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
20026 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
20027
20028These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
20029failures.
20030
20031
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200328.3. Advanced logging options
20033-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020034
20035Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
20036just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
20037options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
20038for more information about their usage.
20039
20040
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200418.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
20042------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020043
20044It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
20045haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
20046commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
20047monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
20048ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
20049
20050 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
20051 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
20052 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
20053 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
20054
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020020055 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
20056 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020057
20058 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
20059 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
20060 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
20061
20062
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200638.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
20064----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020065
20066The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
20067what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
20068or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020069"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020070just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
20071log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
20072after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
20073is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
20074with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
20075with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
20076
20077
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200788.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
20079------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020080
20081Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
20082for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
20083"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
20084retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
20085raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
20086a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
20087file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
20088you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
20089"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
20090
20091
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200928.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
20093--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020094
20095Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
20096multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
20097them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
20098"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
20099logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
20100error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
20101and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
20102too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
20103useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
20104alternative.
20105
20106
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200201078.4. Timing events
20108------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020109
20110Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
20111reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
20112the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
20113frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020114mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
20115addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
20116
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020117Timings events in HTTP mode:
20118
20119 first request 2nd request
20120 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
20121 t tr t tr ...
20122 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
20123 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
20124 :<---- Tq ---->: :
20125 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020126 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020127 :<--------- Ta --------->:
20128
20129Timings events in TCP mode:
20130
20131 TCP session
20132 |<----------------->|
20133 t t
20134 ---|----|----|----|----|---
20135 | Th Tw Tc Td |
20136 |<------ Tt ------->|
20137
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020138 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020139 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020140 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
20141 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
20142 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020143 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020144 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
20145 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
20146 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
20147 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020148
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020149 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
20150 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
20151 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020152 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
20153 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
20154 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
20155 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
20156 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
20157 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020158
20159 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
20160 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
20161 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
20162 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
20163 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
20164 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
20165 request typed by hand during a test.
20166
20167 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
20168 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020169 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020170 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
20171 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
20172 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
20173 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020174
20175 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
20176 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
20177 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
20178 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
20179 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
20180
20181 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
20182 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
20183 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
20184 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
20185 connection never established.
20186
20187 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
20188 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
20189 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
20190 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
20191 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
20192 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
20193 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
20194 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
20195 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
20196 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
20197 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
20198
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020199 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
20200 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
20201 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
20202 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
20203 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
20204 by subtracting other timers when valid :
20205
20206 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
20207
20208 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
20209 "Ta" can never be negative.
20210
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020211 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
20212 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020213 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
20214 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020215 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020216
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020217 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020218
20219 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020220 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
20221 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020222
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020223 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
20224 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
20225 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
20226 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
20227 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
20228 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
20229 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
20230 prefixed with a '+' sign.
20231
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020232These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
20233protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
20234that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020235due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
20236"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
20237that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020238
20239Most common cases :
20240
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020241 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
20242 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
20243 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
20244 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
20245 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
20246 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
20247 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
20248 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
20249 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
20250 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
20251 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020020252 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020253
20254 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
20255 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
20256 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
20257 of ms on remote networks.
20258
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020020259 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
20260 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
20261 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020262
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020263 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
20264 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
20265 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
20266 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
20267 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
20268 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
20269 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
20270 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
20271 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020272
20273Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
20274
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020275 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020276 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020277 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020278
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020279 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020280 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
20281 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
20282
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020283 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020284 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
20285 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
20286 flags.
20287
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020288 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
20289 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020290 Check the session termination flags, then check the
20291 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
20292 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
20293 the client connection was maintained open.
20294
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020295 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020296 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020297 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020298 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
20299
20300
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200203018.5. Session state at disconnection
20302-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020303
20304TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
20305"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
203062-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
20307each of which has a special meaning :
20308
20309 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
20310 session to terminate :
20311
20312 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
20313
20314 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
20315 server explicitly refused it.
20316
20317 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
20318 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
20319 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
20320 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020321 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020020322
20323 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
20324 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020325
20326 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
20327 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
20328 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
20329 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
20330 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
20331
20332 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
20333 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
20334 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
20335 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
20336 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
20337
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090020338 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
20339 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
20340
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070020341 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
20342 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
20343 backup connections when going up.
20344
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020020345 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
20346
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020347 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
20348 send or receive data.
20349
20350 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
20351 send or receive data.
20352
20353 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
20354 with nothing left in the buffers.
20355
20356 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
20357
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010020358 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020359 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
20360
20361 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
20362 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
20363 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
20364 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
20365 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
20366
20367 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
20368 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
20369
20370 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
20371 server (HTTP only).
20372
20373 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
20374
20375 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
20376 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
20377 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
20378
20379 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
20380 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
20381 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
20382
20383 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
20384
20385 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
20386 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
20387
20388 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
20389 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
20390 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
20391
20392 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
20393 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020020394 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
20395 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020396
20397 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
20398 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
20399 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
20400 another server.
20401
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020402 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020403 server.
20404
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020405 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
20406 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
20407 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
20408 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
20409
20410 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
20411 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
20412 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
20413 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
20414
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020020415 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
20416 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
20417 "use-server" rule).
20418
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020419 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
20420
20421 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
20422 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
20423
20424 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
20425
20426 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
20427 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
20428 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
20429
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020430 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
20431 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020432 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020433 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
20434 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
20435
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020436 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
20437
20438 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
20439 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
20440
20441 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
20442
20443 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
20444
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020445The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
20446was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020447helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
20448starvation, attacks, etc...
20449
20450The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
20451alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
20452easier finding and understanding.
20453
20454 Flags Reason
20455
20456 -- Normal termination.
20457
20458 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
20459 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
20460 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
20461 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
20462
20463 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
20464 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
20465 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
20466 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
20467 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
20468 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020469
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020470 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
20471 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020020472 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020473
20474 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
20475 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
20476 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
20477
20478 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
20479 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
20480 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
20481 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
20482 the server takes too long to respond.
20483
20484 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
20485 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
20486 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
20487 long a time to respond.
20488
20489 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
20490 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
20491 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
20492 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020493 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
20494 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020495
20496 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
20497 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
20498 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
20499 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
20500 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020020501 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020502 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
20503 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
20504 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
20505 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
20506 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
20507 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
20508 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
20509 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020510 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020511 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
20512 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
20513 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020514
20515 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
20516 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020020517 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
20518 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
20519 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
20520 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020521
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020020522 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
20523 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
20524
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020525 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020526 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
20527 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020528 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020529 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
20530 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
20531
20532 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
20533 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
20534 503 or 504 here.
20535
20536 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
20537 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
20538 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
20539 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
20540 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
20541
20542 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
20543 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020544 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020545 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
20546 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
20547
20548 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
20549 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
20550 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
20551 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
20552 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
20553 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
20554 between haproxy and the server.
20555
20556 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
20557 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
20558 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
20559 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
20560 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
20561 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
20562 solution is to fix the application.
20563
20564 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
20565 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
20566 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
20567 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
20568 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
20569 external attacks.
20570
20571 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070020572 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020020573 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020574 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
20575 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
20576
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020577 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
20578 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
20579 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020580 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020020581 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020582
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020583 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
20584 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
20585 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
20586 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020587 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
20588 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
20589 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
20590 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
20591 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020592
20593 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
20594 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
20595 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
20596 returned an HTTP 403 error.
20597
20598 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
20599 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
20600 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
20601 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
20602
20603 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
20604 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
20605 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
20606 only be solved by proper system tuning.
20607
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020608The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
20609persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
20610important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
20611re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
20612
20613 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
20614
20615 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
20616 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
20617 set on a GET request.
20618
20619 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
20620 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020621 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020622 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
20623
20624 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
20625 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
20626 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
20627
20628 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
20629 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
20630 already got a cookie.
20631
20632 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
20633 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
20634 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
20635 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
20636 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
20637
20638 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
20639 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
20640 new cookie was inserted in the response.
20641
20642 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
20643 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
20644 new cookie was inserted in the response.
20645
20646 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
20647 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
20648
20649 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
20650 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
20651 then advertised in the response.
20652
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020653
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206548.6. Non-printable characters
20655-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020656
20657In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
20658consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
20659converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
20660prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
20661being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
20662escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
20663is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
20664'}' when logging headers.
20665
20666Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
20667issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
20668containing spaces is "User-Agent".
20669
20670Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
20671the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
20672performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
20673
20674
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206758.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
20676---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020677
20678Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
20679achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020680section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020681cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
20682the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
20683the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020684locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020685not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
20686user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
20687a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
20688wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
20689
20690 Examples :
20691 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
20692 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
20693
20694 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
20695 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
20696
20697
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206988.8. Capturing HTTP headers
20699---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020700
20701Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
20702proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
20703the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
20704server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
20705
20706Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
20707response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020708section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020709
20710It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020711time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
20712appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020713are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
20714and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
20715follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
20716request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
20717in the logs.
20718
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020020719As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
20720frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
20721an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
20722
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020723 Example :
20724 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
20725 listen proxy-out
20726 mode http
20727 option httplog
20728 option logasap
20729 log global
20730 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
20731
20732 # log the name of the virtual server
20733 capture request header Host len 20
20734
20735 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
20736 capture request header Content-Length len 10
20737
20738 # log the beginning of the referrer
20739 capture request header Referer len 20
20740
20741 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
20742 capture response header Server len 20
20743
20744 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
20745 capture response header Content-Length len 10
20746
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020747 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020748 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
20749
20750 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
20751 capture response header Via len 20
20752
20753 # log the URL location during a redirection
20754 capture response header Location len 20
20755
20756 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
20757 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
20758 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20759 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
20760 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
20761
20762 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
20763 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
20764 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20765 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020766 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020767
20768 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
20769 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
20770 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20771 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
20772 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020773 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020774
20775
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207768.9. Examples of logs
20777---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020778
20779These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
20780them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
20781reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
20782
20783 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
20784 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
20785 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
20786
20787 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
20788 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
20789
20790 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
20791 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
20792 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
20793
20794 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
20795 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
20796
20797 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
20798 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
20799 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
20800
20801 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020802 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020803 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
20804 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
20805
20806 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
20807 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
20808 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
20809
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020020810 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
20811 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
20812 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
20813 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
20814 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
20815 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020816
20817 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020818 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020819
20820 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
20821 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
20822 Nothing was sent to any server.
20823
20824 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
20825 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
20826
20827 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
20828 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020829 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020830 send a 408 return code to the client.
20831
20832 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
20833 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
20834
20835 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
20836 5 seconds ("c----").
20837
20838 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
20839 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020840 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020841
20842 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020843 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020844 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
20845 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
20846 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
20847 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
20848 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010020849
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020020850
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200208519. Supported filters
20852--------------------
20853
20854Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
20855accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
20856unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
20857
20858See also : "filter"
20859
208609.1. Trace
20861----------
20862
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010020863filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020864
20865 Arguments:
20866 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
20867 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
20868
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010020869 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020870
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020871 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020872 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
20873 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
20874 amount of the parsed data.
20875
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020876 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010020877
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020878This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
20879callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
20880information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
20881filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
20882
20883Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
20884tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
20885a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
20886
20887
208889.2. HTTP compression
20889---------------------
20890
20891filter compression
20892
20893The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
20894keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020895when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
20896fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
20897done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
20898explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
20899filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
20900listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20901order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020902
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020903See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
20904 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020905
20906
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200209079.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
20908--------------------------------------------
20909
20910filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
20911
20912 Arguments :
20913
20914 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
20915 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
20916 parsed.
20917
20918 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
20919 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
20920 part must be placed in its own scope.
20921
20922The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
20923external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020924streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020020925exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
20926also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
20927
20928SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
20929the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
20930
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010020931For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020020932"doc/SPOE.txt".
20933
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100209349.4. Cache
20935----------
20936
20937filter cache <name>
20938
20939 Arguments :
20940
20941 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
20942
20943The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
20944"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020945cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020946other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
20947case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
20948is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
20949filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010020950listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20951order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010020952
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020953See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
20954 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
20955
20956
209579.5. Fcgi-app
20958-------------
20959
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040020960filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020961
20962 Arguments :
20963
20964 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
20965
20966The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
20967request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
20968reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
20969used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
20970implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
20971used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
20972fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
20973used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20974order.
20975
20976See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
20977 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
20978
20979
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100209809.6. OpenTracing
20981----------------
20982
20983The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
20984HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
20985of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
20986Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
20987
20988This feature is only enabled when haproxy was built with USE_OT=1.
20989
20990The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
20991HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
20992participates in the work of HAProxy.
20993
20994filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
20995
20996 Arguments :
20997
20998 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
20999 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
21000 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
21001 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
21002 OpenTracing filters.
21003
21004 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
21005 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
21006 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
21007 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
21008 filter must have its own scope defined.
21009
21010More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
21011of the filter can be found in the contrib/opentracing directory.
21012
21013
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002101410. FastCGI applications
21015-------------------------
21016
21017HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
21018feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
21019the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
21020FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
21021servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
21022FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
21023backend.
21024
21025HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
21026application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
21027connection.
21028
2102910.1. Setup
21030-----------
21031
2103210.1.1. Fcgi-app section
21033--------------------------
21034
21035fcgi-app <name>
21036 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
21037 document root must be defined.
21038
21039acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
21040 Declare or complete an access list.
21041
21042 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
21043 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
21044 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
21045 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
21046 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
21047
21048docroot <path>
21049 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
21050 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
21051 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
21052
21053index <script-name>
21054 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
21055 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
21056 is an optional setting.
21057
21058 Example :
21059 index index.php
21060
21061log-stderr global
21062log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010021063 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021064 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
21065
21066 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
21067 default STDERR messages are ignored.
21068
21069pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21070 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
21071 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
21072 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21073
21074 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
21075 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
21076 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
21077 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
21078
21079 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
21080 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
21081
21082path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021083 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021084 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
21085 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
21086 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
21087 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
21088 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
21089 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
21090 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021091
21092 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021093 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021094 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
21095 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
21096 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
21097 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021098
21099 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021100 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
21101 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021102
21103option get-values
21104no option get-values
21105 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
21106
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021107 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021108 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
21109
21110 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
21111 application will accept.
21112
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020021113 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
21114 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021115
21116 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050021117 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021118 option is disabled.
21119
21120 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
21121 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
21122 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
21123 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
21124 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
21125 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
21126
21127option keep-conn
21128no option keep-conn
21129 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
21130 sending a response.
21131
21132 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
21133 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
21134
21135option max-reqs <reqs>
21136 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
21137 accept.
21138
21139 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
21140 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
21141 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
21142 to 1.
21143
21144option mpxs-conns
21145no option mpxs-conns
21146 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
21147
21148 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
21149 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
21150
21151set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21152 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
21153 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
21154 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
21155 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21156
21157 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
21158 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
21159 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
21160
21161 Example :
21162 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
21163 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
21164
21165 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
21166
21167
2116810.1.2. Proxy section
21169---------------------
21170
21171use-fcgi-app <name>
21172 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
21173
21174 Arguments :
21175 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
21176
21177 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
21178 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
21179 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
21180 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
21181 application may be defined at a time per backend.
21182
21183 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
21184 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
21185 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
21186 application are evaluated.
21187
21188
2118910.1.3. Example
21190---------------
21191
21192 frontend front-http
21193 mode http
21194 bind *:80
21195 bind *:
21196
21197 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
21198 default_backend back-static
21199
21200 backend back-static
21201 mode http
21202 server www A.B.C.D:80
21203
21204 backend back-dynamic
21205 mode http
21206 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
21207 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
21208
21209 fcgi-app php-fpm
21210 log-stderr global
21211 option keep-conn
21212
21213 docroot /var/www/my-app
21214 index index.php
21215 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
21216
21217
2121810.2. Default parameters
21219------------------------
21220
21221A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
21222the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021223script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021224applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
21225
21226 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21227 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
21228 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
21229 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
21230 | | |
21231 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21232 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
21233 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
21234 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
21235 | | application. |
21236 | | |
21237 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21238 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
21239 | | the request. It may not be set. |
21240 | | |
21241 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21242 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
21243 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
21244 | | the application's configuration. |
21245 | | |
21246 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21247 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
21248 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
21249 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
21250 | | |
21251 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21252 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
21253 | | following the part that identifies the script |
21254 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
21255 | | be defined. |
21256 | | |
21257 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21258 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
21259 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
21260 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
21261 | | is not set too. |
21262 | | |
21263 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21264 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
21265 | | set. |
21266 | | |
21267 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21268 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
21269 | | the request. |
21270 | | |
21271 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21272 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
21273 | | client as part of user authentication. |
21274 | | |
21275 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21276 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
21277 | | script to process the request. |
21278 | | |
21279 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21280 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
21281 | | |
21282 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21283 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
21284 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
21285 | | |
21286 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21287 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
21288 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
21289 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
21290 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
21291 | | |
21292 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21293 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
21294 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
21295 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
21296 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
21297 | | side. |
21298 | | |
21299 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21300 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
21301 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
21302 | | connected to. |
21303 | | |
21304 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21305 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
21306 | | |
21307 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21308 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
21309 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
21310 | | |
21311 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21312
21313
2131410.3. Limitations
21315------------------
21316
21317The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
21318way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
21319during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
21320establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
21321application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
21322or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
21323message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
21324these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
21325and HTTP servers under the same backend.
21326
21327Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
21328request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
21329requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
21330
21331About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
21332into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
21333fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
21334"http-request" ones.
21335
21336Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
21337FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
21338processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
21339must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
21340here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010021341
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010021342/*
21343 * Local variables:
21344 * fill-column: 79
21345 * End:
21346 */